SM
PCSVision PicturePhone
PM-8200
User’s Guide
Using Speed Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Using Abbreviated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Entering Text . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Selecting a Character Input Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Entering Characters Using T9 Text Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Entering Characters by Tapping the Keypad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Entering Symbols, Numbers, Preset Suffixes, and Smileys . . . . . . . . . .34
2B. ControllingYour Phone’s Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Sound Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Ringer Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
Selecting a Tone Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Setting a Start-up/Power-off Tone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Using Voice Prompt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40
Adjusting the Phone’s Volume Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Alert Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Silence All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Display Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Changing the Text Greeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Changing the Backlight Time Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45
Changing the Display Screen Animation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Changing the Display for Incoming Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47
Changing the Display for Area Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Changing the Display for Standby Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49
Changing the Screen Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Changing the Display for My Buddy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Changing the Background . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51
Changing the Font Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Location Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Airplane Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
TTY Use With PCS Service From Sprint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Phone Setup Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Shortcut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Auto Answer Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
Setting the Open/Close Flip Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Setting Any Key Answer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Setting the Side Key Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Setting Abbreviated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Headset Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Sleep Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Setting Message Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Editing Preset Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Setting a Callback Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Setting the Current Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Display Language . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
Using the Mini Flashlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63
2C. SettingYour Phone’s Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .64
Accessing the Security Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Using Your Phone’s Lock Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Locking Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Unlocking Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Locking the Pictures Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Changing the Lock Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Calling in Lock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Restricting Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Using Special Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Erasing the Contacts Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Erasing All Downloads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Resetting Your Pictures Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Resetting Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Resetting and Locking Your Phone Through SMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
SM
Security Features for PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
Enabling and Disabling PCS Vision Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .72
2D. ControllingYour Roaming Experience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73
Understanding Roaming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Setting Your Phone’s Roam Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Controlling Roaming Charges Using Call Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
2E. NavigatingThrough Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Menu Navigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Menu Structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79
Viewing the Menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
2F. Managing Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
Viewing History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Call History Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Making a Call From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Saving a Phone Number From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Prepending a Phone Number From Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Erasing Call History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
2G. Using the Contacts Directory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88
Displaying the Contacts List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Adding a New Contacts Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Finding Contacts List Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Contacts List Entry Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Adding a Phone Number to a Contacts Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Editing a Contacts Entry’s Phone Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Assigning Speed Dial Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
Editing a Contacts Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Selecting a Ringer/Image Type for an Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
Secret Contacts Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Dialing PCS Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
2H. Personal Organizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Managing the Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Using Your Phone’s Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Adding an Event to the Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Event Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Event Alert Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Viewing Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Erasing a Day’s Events or Call Alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Adding a Call Alarm to the Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Call Alarm Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Call Alarm Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
Editing a Call Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Viewing a Future/Past Day’s Scheduled Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Adding To Do List Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Viewing the To Do List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Editing To Do List Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Adding a To Do List Item to the Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Deleting Items From the To Do List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108
Viewing Memory in Your Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Purging All Events, Call Alarms, or To Do List Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Personal Information Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Displaying Your User Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Finding Icon Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Displaying the Version Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Displaying Advanced Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Using Your Phone’s Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Using the Alarm Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Using the Calculator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Using the World Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Downloading Files Through PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
Confirming the Downloaded Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Viewing the Downloaded Data Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
2I. UsingYour Phone’s Voice Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Using Voice-Activated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Making a Call Using Voice-Activated Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Programming Voice Dial Tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
Reviewing Voice Dial Tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Erasing All Voice Dial Tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
Managing Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Recording Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Voice Memo Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
Erasing Voice Memos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
Setting Up Screen Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Activating Screen Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Selecting an Announcement for Screen Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
Recording Your Name for a Pre-Recorded Announcement . . . . . . . .130
Recording a Customized Announcement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Reviewing an Announcement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
Erasing an Announcement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .131
2J. Using PCS Ready Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Getting Started With PCS Ready Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Setting PCS Ready Link Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Preparing Your Phone for PCS Ready Link Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Ready Link Call Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Making and Receiving a PCS Ready Link Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Displaying the PCS Ready Link List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Selecting Contact Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135
Making a PCS Ready Link Call (1-to-1 Call) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
Making a PCS Ready Link Call (Group Call) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Making a PCS Ready Link Call by Entering a Number . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Missed Call Notification for PCS Ready Link Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
Receiving a PCS Ready Link Call (1-to-1 Call) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Receiving a PCS Ready Link Call (Group Call) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
Redialing a PCS Ready Link Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
PCS Ready Link Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
Adding and Editing Ready Link Contacts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Copying an Entry to Personal List or Personal Group List . . . . . . . . .141
Saving a PCS Ready Link Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Finding an Entry in the PCS Ready Link List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Adding a New Contact to Your Personal List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Adding a New Group to Your Personal Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .144
Editing a Contact in Your Personal List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Editing a Group in Your Personal Group List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Erasing Ready Link List Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Erasing an Entry in Your Personal List or Personal Group List . . . . . .147
Erasing a PCS Ready Link List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Updating Your PCS Ready Link Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Updating the Company List and Personal List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Managing PCS Ready Link Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Setting Speed Dialing for PCS Ready Link Entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
Restarting the Ready Link Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Setting Ready Link Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Setting Ringer Types for PCS Ready Link Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Setting an Alert Notification for PCS Ready Link Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Setting the Speakerphone for PCS Ready Link Calls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Setting the Default View of the PCS Ready Link List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
2K. UsingYour Phone’s Built-in Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .152
Taking Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
SM
Creating Your Picture Mail Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Camera Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Selecting Camera Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Viewing Your Camera’s Status Area Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .160
SM
Sending Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Sending Picture Mail From the In Camera Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
Sending Picture Mail from Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Storing Pictures in My Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
In Camera Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
In Camera Folder Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .166
Saved to Phone Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
Managing Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Using the Picture Mail Website . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Managing Online Picture Mail From Your PCS Vision Phone . . . . . .170
Uploading Your Pictures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
Sending Online Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
AccessingOnlinePictureMailOptionsFromYourPCSVisionPhone . .172
Section3:PCSServiceFeatures ......................174
3A. PCSServiceFeatures:TheBasics ........................175
Using Voicemail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Setting Up Your Voicemail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Voicemail Notification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
New Voicemail Message Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Retrieving Your Voicemail Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Voicemail Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179
Clearing the Message Icon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
Voicemail Menu Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
Using Caller ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Responding to Call Waiting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Making a Three-Way Call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
Using Call Forwarding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
SM
3B. PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
Getting Started With PCS Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Your User Name . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Launching a PCS Vision Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Net Guard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
PCS Vision Connection Status and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Navigating the Web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
Understanding Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Message Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
New Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
Message Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Displaying Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Displaying Picture Mail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .194
Sending a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
Sending a Message in the Drafts Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Sending a Message in the Outbox Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Message Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Changing the Display Font Size of a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Prepending a Phone Number From a Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199
Message Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Erasing All Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Moving a Message Into Another Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Erasing a Folder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Erasing Selected Messages in All Folders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Signing Up for Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Using Email . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Accessing Email Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Composing Email Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Accessing Alternate Email Providers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Using Alternate Email Providers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Using Instant Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Accessing Instant Messaging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Experiencing Wireless Online Chat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Downloading Premium Services Content . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Accessing Games . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Accessing Ringers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Accessing Screen Savers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Exploring the Web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Using the Browser Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Using PCS Business Connection Personal Edition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
PCS Vision FAQs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222
SM
3C. PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
SM
Getting Started With PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Creating Your Own Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Making a Call With PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Accessing Information Using PCS Voice Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Section4:SafetyGuidelinesandWarrantyInformation . .226
4A. Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .227
Getting the Most Out of Your Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
Maintaining Safe Use of and Access to Your Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .229
Caring for the Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Acknowledging Special Precautions and the FCC Notice . . . . . . . . . . .232
Consumer Information on Wireless Phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Owner’s Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
User’s Guide Proprietary Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
4B. Terms & Conditions and Manufacturer’s Warranty . . . . . . .250
Terms and Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Manufacturer’s Warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Welcome to Sprint
Sprinthasthemostcomplete, all-digitalwirelessnetworkinthenation.
Dependonit. We are committed to bringing you the best wireless
technology available. With Sprint, you get the most complete,
all-digital wireless network in the nation so all your services work
the same wherever you go on the network. We built our network
right from the start, so no matter where you are on the enhanced
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, all your services – whether it’s
Voicemail, Caller ID, email, or Picture Mail – will work the same.
This guide will familiarize you with our technology and your new
PCS Vision Phone through simple, easy-to-follow instructions. If
you have already reviewed the StartHeretoActivate guide that was
packaged with your new phone, then you’re ready to explore the
advanced features outlined in this guide.
If you have not read your StartHeretoActivate guide, go to
Section One – Getting Started. This section provides all the
information you need to unlock your phone, set up your voicemail,
and much more. It also contains information on how to contact
Sprint if you have any questions about your service, wish to check
your account balance, or want to purchase additional products or
services.
Sprint is different. All your services work the same wherever you
go on the most complete, all-digital wireless network in the nation.
Welcome and thank you for choosing Sprint.
i
Introduction
This User’sGuide introduces you to PCS Service and all the features
of your new phone. It’s divided into four sections:
ࡗ Section1: Getting Started ࡗ Section2: Your PCS Vision Phone ࡗ Section3: PCS Service Features ࡗ Section4: Safety Guidelines and Warranty Information Throughout this guide, you’ll find tips that highlight special
shortcuts and timely reminders to help you make the most of your
new phone and service. The Table of Contents and Index will also
help you quickly locate specific information.
You’ll get the most out of your phone if you read each section.
However, if you’d like to get right to a specific feature, simply locate
that section in the Table of Contents and click on the page number
to go directly to that page. Follow the instructions in that section,
and you’ll be ready to use your phone in no time.
Note: You can view this guide online or print it to keep it on hand. If you’re viewing
it online, simply click on a topic in the Table of Contents or Index or on any page
reference. The PDF will automatically display the appropriate page.
ii
Section 1
Getting Started
Section 1A
Setting Up Service
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ GettingStartedWithPCS Service
SettingUpYourVoicemail
PCSAccountPasswords
GettingHelp
SettingupserviceonyournewPCSVisionPhoneisquickandeasy.
This section walks you through the necessary steps to set up
your phone, unlock your phone, set up your voicemail, establish
passwords, and contact Sprint for assistance with your PCS Service.
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
2
Getting StartedWith PCS Service
DeterminingifYourPhoneisAlreadyActivated
If you received your phone in the mail or purchased it at a Sprint Store,
it probably has already been activated. All you need to do is unlock
your phone.
If your phone is not activated, please refer to the Start Here Guide
included with your phone.
UnlockingYourPhone
Tounlockyourphone,followtheseeasysteps:
1. Press
to turn the phone on.
2. Press Unlock (left softkey).
Note: To select a softkey, press the softkey button directly below the softkey text
that appears at the bottom left and bottom right of your phone’s display screen.
Softkey actions change according to the screen you’re viewing and will not
appear if there is no corresponding action available.
3. Enter your four-digit lock code. (For security purposes, the
code is not visible as you type.)
Tip: If you can’t recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your
Social Security number or PCS Phone Number or try 0000. If none of these work,
call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
3
Setting Up YourVoicemail
All unanswered calls to your PCS Vision Phone are automatically
transferred to your voicemail, even if your phone is in use or turned
off. Therefore, you will want to set up your voicemail and personal
greeting as soon as your PCS Vision Phone is activated.
Tosetupyourvoicemail:
1. Press and hold
.
2. Follow the system prompts to:
Ⅲ
Create your passcode
Ⅲ
Record your greeting
Ⅲ
Record your name announcement
Ⅲ
Choose whether or not to activate One-Touch Message
Access (a feature that lets you access messages simply by
pressing and holding
enter your passcode)
, bypassing the need for you to
Note: The voicemail setup process may vary in certain Affiliate areas.
For more information about using your voicemail, see
“Using Voicemail” on page 176.
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
4
PCSAccount Passwords
As a PCS customer, you enjoy unlimited access to your personal
account information, your voicemail account, and your PCS Vision
account. To ensure that no one else has access to your information,
you will need to create passwords to protect your privacy.
AccountPassword
If you are the account owner, you’ll have an account password to sign
Solutions. Your default account password is the last four digits of your
Social Security number. If you are not the account owner (if someone
else pays for your PCS Service), you can get a sub-account password
VoicemailPassword
You’ll create your voicemail password (or passcode) when you set up
your voicemail. See “Setting Up Your Voicemail” on page 176 for
more information on your voicemail password.
PCSVisionPassword
If you have a PCS Vision Phone, you can set up a PCS Vision Password.
This optional password may be used to authorize purchase of
Premium Services content and to protect personal information on
multi-phone accounts.
For more information or to change your passwords, sign on to
www.sprintpcs.com or call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS
(4727).
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
5
Getting Help
VisitOurWebsite
You can get up-to-date information on PCS Services and Options by
When you visit us online, you can
ⅷ
Review coverage maps
ⅷ
Learn how to use voicemail
ⅷ
Access your account information
ⅷ
Purchase accessories
ⅷ
Add additional options to your service plan
ⅷ
Check out frequently asked questions
ⅷ
And more
ReachingPCSCustomerSolutions
You can reach PCS Customer Solutions many different ways:
ⅷ
Dial
on your PCS Vision Phone
ⅷ
ⅷ
Sign on to your account at www.sprintpcs.com
Call us toll-free at 1-888-211-4727 (Consumer customers),
SM
1-877-CLEARPY (253-2779) (PCS Clear Pay customers), or
1-888-788-4727 (Business customers)
ⅷ
Write to us at PCS Customer Solutions, P.O. Box 8077,
London, KY 40742
ReceivingAutomatedInvoicingInformation
For your convenience, your phone gives you access to invoicing
information on your PCS Account. This information includes
balance due, payment received, invoicing cycle, and the number of
minutes used since your last invoicing cycle. (Normal airtime usage
will apply.)
Toaccessautomatedinvoicing information:
ᮣ
Press
.
Note: This service may not be available in all Affiliate areas.
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
6
PCSDirectoryAssistance
You have access to a variety of services and information through
PCS Directory Assistance, including residential, business, and
government listings; assistance with local or long-distance calls;
movie listings; and hotel, restaurant, shopping, and major local event
information. There is a per-call charge and you will be billed for
airtime.
TocallPCSDirectoryAssistance:
ᮣ
Press
.
PCSOperatorServices
PCS Operator Services provides assistance when placing collect calls
or when placing calls billed to a local telephone calling card or third
party.
ToaccessPCSOperatorServices:
ᮣ
Press
.
For more information or to see the latest in products and services,
Note: PCS Operator Services may not be available in all Affiliate areas.
Section 1A: Setting Up Service
7
Section 2
Your PCS Vision Phone
Section 2A
Your PCS Vision Phone: The Basics
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ FrontViewofYourPhone
ViewingtheDisplayScreen
SM
FeaturesofYourPCSVision PicturePhonePM-8200
TurningYour PhoneOnandOff
UsingYourPhone’sBatteryandCharger
DisplayingYourPhoneNumber
MakingandAnsweringCalls
EnteringText
YourPCSVisionPhoneispackedwithfeaturesthatsimplifyyourlifeand
expandyourabilitytostayconnectedtothepeopleandinformationthat
areimportanttoyou. This section will guide you through the basic
functions and calling features of your phone.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
9
FrontView ofYour Phone
1. Earpiece
S p r i n t
M a r 0 1 , 0 4 ( M o n )
1 2 : 3 0 p m
2. Main LCD
R-Link
Web
3. Softkey (left)
17. Softkey (right)
16. Side Call Key
4. Navigation Key
15. BACK
5. MENU/OK
14. Side Camera Key
6. Camera Key
13. END/POWER
7. TALK
12. SPEAKER Key
11. Keypad
8. Microphone
9. Accessories Connector
10. Charger Jack
23. Antenna
24. Headset
Jack
18. Speaker
25. Ready Link
(Memo) Button
19. LED
Indicator
S p r i n t
1 2 : 3 0 p M a r 0 1
20. Sub LCD
26. Side Volume
Key
21. Flash
22. Camera
Lens
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
10
Key Features
1. Earpiece: Lets you hear the caller’s voice.
2. MainLCD(display): Displays the phone’s main menu, features,
modes, etc.
3. Softkey(left): Lets you select the menu corresponding to the
bottom left line on the Main LCD.
4. NavigationKey: Lets you navigate quickly and easily through the
menu options. You can access menu shortcuts by pressing
Right : Contacts, Left : My Shortcut, Up : Messaging, and
Down : Downloads.
5. MENU/OK: Lets you access the phone’s menus and select menu
options.
6. CameraKey: Lets you access the Pictures menu and take pictures.
7. TALK: Lets you place or receive calls, answer Call Waiting, or use
Three-Way Calling and Voice Dial.
8. Microphone: To speak into or record your voice.
9. AccessoriesConnector: Connects optional accessories such as a
USB cable.
10. ChargerJack: Connects the travel charger (included).
11. Keypad: Lets you enter numbers, letters, and characters, and
navigate within menus. Press and hold keys 2-9 for speed dialing.
12. SPEAKERKey: Lets you place or receive calls in speakerphone
mode. You can also use it to activate Voice Dial and Memo
recording.
13. END/POWER: Lets you turn the phone on/off, end a call, or
return to standby mode.
14. SideCameraKey: Lets you display the Pictures menu and take
pictures.
15. BACK: Lets you clear characters from the screen or display the
previous page.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
11
16. SideCallKey: Lets you place or receive calls without opening the
phone.
17. Softkey(right): Lets you select the menu corresponding to the
bottom right line on the Main LCD.
18. Speaker: Lets you hear the different ringers and sounds.
You can mute the ringer when receiving incoming calls by
pressing
,
,
,
,
, or Side Camera key.
19. LEDIndicator: Shows your phone’s connection status at a glance.
20. SubLCD: Lets you monitor the phone’s status and see who’s
calling without opening the phone.
21. Flash: The built-in flash lets you take pictures in low light.
You can also use it as a mini flashlight.
22. CameraLens: The built-in camera lens lets you take pictures.
23. Antenna: Fully extend the antenna for the best reception.
24. HeadsetJack: Lets you insert the plug of a headset (sold
separately) for hands-free phone use.
25. ReadyLink(Memo)Button: Allows you to access the PCS Ready
Link List or Voice Memo menu. (See “Using PCS Ready Link” on
page 132 or “Managing Voice Memos” on page 126.)
26. SideVolumeKey: Lets you adjust the receiver volume during a
call or ringer volume in standby mode.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
12
Viewing the Display Screen
Your phone’s display screen provides a wealth of information about
your phone’s status and options. This list identifies the symbols you’ll
see on your phone’s display screen:
shows your current signal strength. The more lines you have, the
stronger your signal.
means your phone cannot find a signal.
tells you a call is in progress.
indicates PCS Vision/PCS Ready Link access is dormant.
indicates PCS Vision/PCS Ready Link access is active.
indicates PCS Vision/PCS Ready Link access is disabled.
indicates you have new text messages waiting.
indicates you have new voicemail messages waiting. Press and
hold
to call your voicemail box.
indicates you have text messages and voicemail messages waiting.
indicatesyouare“roaming” offtheSprintNationwidePCSNetwork.
indicates the PCS Ready Link Service is enabled.
indicates the PCS Ready Link Service is disabled.
shows the level of your battery charge. The more black you see,
the more power you have left. It displays
while charging.
indicates you have menus to scroll (in four directions).
indicates a beep sound is set at level 1.
indicates the vibrate feature is set.
indicates volume level 4 or 1 and vibrate feature is set.
indicates the voice call ringer setting is off.
indicates all the sound settings are off.
indicates the Location Service of your phone is enabled.
indicates the Location Service of your phone is disabled.
indicates you have a new caller’s message.
indicates the Screen Call Auto setting is on.
indicates you have new downloaded data.
indicates your phone is in TTY mode.
indicates Headset mode is set to PCS Ready Link and a headset is
connected.
indicates the speakerphone mode is set to on.
Note: Display indicators help you manage your roaming charges by letting you
know when you’re off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and whether you’re
operating in digital or analog mode. (For more information, see Section 2D:
Controlling Your Roaming Experience on page 73.)
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
13
SM
Features ofYour PCSVision Picture Phone
PM-8200
SM
Congratulations on the purchase of your PCS Vision Picture Phone
PM-8200 by Sanyo. This phone is lightweight, easy-to-use and
reliable, and it also offers many significant features and service
options. The following list previews some of those features and
options and provides page numbers where you can find out more:
ⅷ
Dual-band/tri-mode capability allows you to make and receive
calls while on the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and to roam
on other analog and 800 and 1900 MHz digital networks where
Sprint has implemented roaming agreements (page 73).
SM
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
PCS Vision provides access to the wireless Internet in digital
mode (page 186).
Email provides quick and convenient text messaging capabilities
(page 204).
SM
PCS Voice Command lets you dial phone numbers by speaking
someone’s name or the digits of their phone number (page 223).
Games, ringers, screen savers, and other applications can be
downloaded to your phone to make your PCS Vision Phone as
unique as you are (page 208).
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
The built-in organizer lets you schedule alerts to remind you of
important events (page 99).
Speed Dialing lets you call a phone number stored in your
Contacts directory using one touch dialing (page 30).
The Contacts directory can store up to 500 numbers and
300 email and Web addresses in 300 entries (entries can store up
to seven numbers each). A separate PCS Ready Link Contacts List
provides easy access to up to 200 personal contacts and
200 company-provided contacts.
ⅷ
ⅷ
The built-in camera allows you to take full-color digital pictures,
view your pictures using the phone’s display, and instantly send
them to a family and friends using Picture Mail service (page 152).
SM
PCS Ready Link allows you to enjoy quick, two-way,
“walkie-talkie-style” communication with one or several
PCS Ready Link users (page 132).
ⅷ
ⅷ
Large 1.8-inch, full-color display screen plus external display.
The Side Call key lets you place or receive calls without opening
the phone (page 19).
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
14
TurningYour Phone On and Off
TurningYourPhoneOn
Toturnyourphoneon:
ᮣ
Press
.
Once your phone is on, it displays “Looking for service...” which
indicates that your phone is searching for a signal. When your phone
finds a signal, it automatically enters standby mode – the phone’s idle
state. At this point, you are ready to begin making and receiving calls.
If your phone is unable to find a signal after 15 minutes of searching, a
Power Save feature is automatically activated. When a signal is found,
your phone automatically returns to standby mode.
In Power Save mode, your phone searches for a signal periodically
without your intervention. You can also initiate a search for
PCS Service by pressing any key (when your phone is turned on).
Tip: The Power Save feature helps to conserve your battery power when you are
in an area where there is no signal.
TurningYourPhoneOff
Toturnyourphoneoff:
ᮣ
Press and hold
until you see the powering down
animation on the display screen.
Your screen remains blank while your phone is off (unless the battery
is charging).
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
15
UsingYour Phone’s Battery and Charger
BatteryCapacity
Your PCS Vision Phone is equipped with a Lithium Ion (LiIon) battery.
It allows you to recharge your battery before it is fully drained.
The battery provides approximately 3.0 hours of continuous digital
talk time (1.7 hours in analog) or approximately 288 hours of
continuous digital standby time (17 hours in analog).
When the battery reaches 5% of its capacity, the low battery icon
appears. When there are approximately two minutes of talk time left,
the phone sounds an audible alert and then powers down.
Note: Long backlight settings, searching for service, vibrate mode, PCS Ready
Link mode, and browser use affect the battery’s talk and standby times.
Tip: Be sure to watch your phone’s battery level indicator and charge the battery
before it runs out of power.
InstallingtheBattery
ToinstalltheLiIonbattery:
1. Place the battery into the space beneath
the antenna with the metal contacts at
the bottom, facing downward.
2. Gently press down until it’s in place and
the battery release latch snaps.
RemovingtheBattery
Toremoveyourbattery:
1. Make sure the power is off so that you
don’t lose any stored numbers or
messages.
2. Push the battery release latch up and
hold the battery.
3. Pull the battery up and out at a 45-degree
angle.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
16
ChargingtheBattery
Your PCS Vision Phone’s LiIon battery is rechargeable and should be
charged as soon as possible so you can begin using your phone.
Keeping track of your battery’s charge is important. If your battery
level becomes too low, your phone automatically turns off and you
will lose all the information you were just working on. For a quick
check of your phone’s battery level, glance at the battery charge
indicator located in the upper-right corner of your phone’s display
screen. If the battery charge is getting too low, the low battery icon
(
) appears and the phone sounds a warning tone.
Always use a Sprint-approved travel charger or vehicle power adapter
to charge your battery.
Warning! Using the wrong battery charger could cause damage to your phone
and void the warranty.
UsingtheTravel Charger
Tousethetravelchargerprovidedwithyourphone:
1. Plug the travel charger into a wall outlet.
2. Plug the other end of the travel charger into the bottom of your
phone (with the battery installed).
Ⅲ
Chargingwhenyourphoneisturnedon:
The battery icon
appears on the display while charging.
when charging is complete.
Chargingwhenyourphoneisturnedoff:
The battery icon turns to
Ⅲ
The battery icon
appears, and the message “BATTERY
CHARGING--Power Off--” is shown on the display while
charging. When the battery is completely discharged, you
may wait for several minutes until the message is shown on
the display. The battery icon turns to
, and the message
changes to “CHARGING COMPLETE--Power Off--” when
charging is complete.
It takes approximately 3.5 hours to fully recharge a completely
rundown battery. With the Sprint-approved LiIon battery,
you can recharge the battery before it becomes completely
run down.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
17
DisplayingYour Phone Number
Just in case you forget your phone number, your PCS Vision Phone
can remind you.
Todisplayyourphonenumber:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
.
3. Select MyPhone# and press
.
Note: To access the phone’s main menu, press
from standby mode. Menu
items may be selected by highlighting them with the navigation key and pressing
, or you can press the number corresponding to the menu item on your keypad.
Making andAnswering Calls
Making Calls
Placing a call from your PCS Phone is as easy as making a call from any
land line phone. Just enter the number and press
your way to clear calls.
and you’re on
Toplaceacallusingyourkeypad:
1. Make sure your phone is on.
2. Enter a phone number. (If you make a mistake while dialing,
press
to erase one digit at a time. Press and hold
to erase
the entire number.)
3. Press or
. (To place a call when you are roaming and
Call Guard is enabled, see “Controlling Roaming Charges Using
Call Guard” on page 77.)
4. When you’re finished, press
to end the call.
or twice.
Tip: To redial your last outgoing call, press
Tip: When making calls off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, always dial
using 11 digits (1 + area code + phone number).
You can also place calls from your PCS Phone by using PCS Voice
SM
Command (page 223), Speed Dialing (page 30), and using your
Call History listings (page 83).
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
18
Important: To maximize performance when using your PCS Phone, extend the
antenna before a call and do not touch the antenna during a call (see page 228).
Correct
Incorrect
Toplaceacallwiththeflipclosed:
1. Make sure your phone is on.
2. Press and hold the Side Call key (
) on the right side of the
phone. (You will see a message on the Sub LCD.)
3. Follow the system prompts. (The call will be made in
speakerphone mode, unless you have a headset attached to the
phone.)
Ⅲ
Redial to redial the last number you called.
Ⅲ
VoiceDial to use the Voice Dial function (see “Using Voice-
Activated Dialing” on page 124).
4. When you’re finished, press and hold
.
Note: To use a Voice Dial, you must have stored Voice Dial entries (see
“Programming Voice Dial Tags” on page 124).
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
19
Dialing Options
Dialing options are displayed when you press Options (right softkey)
after entering numbers in the phone’s standby mode.
To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
Call to dial the phone number.
ⅷ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone mode.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
SendMessage to send a text message. See page 195 for details.
To send Picture Mail, see page 162.
SavePhone# to save the phone number in your Contacts list. (See
“Saving a Phone Number” on page 27.)
Find to display Contacts list entries that end with the digits you
entered. (See “Finding a Phone Number” on page 28.)
H HardPause to insert a hard pause. (See “Dialing and Saving
Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 28.)
T 2-Sec. Pause to insert a 2-second pause. (See “Dialing and
Saving Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 28.)
Hyphen to insert a hyphen. (Hyphens are generally for visual
appeal only; they are not necessary when entering numbers.)
Note: To speed dial a phone number, press and hold the appropriate speed dial
key (locations 2-9). See “Assigning Speed Dial Numbers” on page 94.
This option appears when you enter four digits and press
.
ⅷ
Abbrev. Dial to dial the phone number in your Contacts list that
ends with the four digits you entered. (See “Using Abbreviated
Dialing” on page 30.)
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
20
Answering Calls
Toansweranincomingcallwiththeflipopen:
1. Make sure your phone is on. (If your phone is off, incoming calls
go to voicemail.)
2. Press
or
to answer an incoming call. (Depending on
your phone’s settings, you may also answer incoming calls by
opening the phone or by pressing any number key. See “Setting
Any Key Answer” on page 58 for more information.)
Toansweranincomingcallwiththeflipclosed:
1. Make sure your phone is on. (If your phone is off, incoming calls
go to voicemail.)
2. When your phone rings or vibrates, press and hold the Side Call
key (
) on the right side of the phone. (The call will be
answered in speakerphone mode.)
– or –
Open the phone to use the earpiece.
Note: If the setting for Open Flip is not set to “Answer Call,” opening the phone
will not answer the call. (See “Setting the Open/Close Flip Option” on page 57.)
Your PCS Vision Phone notifies you of incoming calls in the
following ways:
ⅷ
The phone rings or vibrates.
ⅷ
The LED flashes.
ⅷ
The backlight illuminates.
ⅷ
The screen displays an incoming call message.
ⅷ
If available, the phone number of the caller is displayed.
ⅷ
If the phone number is in your Contacts list, the contact’s name is
displayed.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
21
The following options are also displayed by pressing Options (right
softkey). To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
CallGuard to answer the call when you are in roaming mode.
See page 77 for setting Call Guard.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
Answer to answer the call.
Answer:Speaker to answer the call in speakerphone mode.
Don’tAnswer to hang up the incoming call and return to the Web
or camera mode while you are in Web or Camera operation.
(This feature appears only when PCS Vision access is dormant or
when your phone is in camera mode.)
ⅷ
ⅷ
ScreenCall to answer the call by using a pre-recorded
announcement. (This feature appears only when you are in a
PCS Service area or digital roaming area. See page 129.)
QuietRinger to mute the ringer. (This feature appears only when
the ringer is set.)
Tip: Your PCS Phone offers additional ways to answer calls. (See page 56 for
Auto Answer and see page 58 for Any Key Answer.)
AnsweringaRoamCallWithCallGuardEnabled
Call Guard is an option that helps you manage your roaming charges
when making or receiving calls while outside the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network. Please see Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming
Experience for more information about roaming.
ToansweracallwhenyouareroamingandCallGuardisenabled:
1. Press
or
. (The following message will appear:
“Roaming rate applies. Please press [1] to accept.”)
2. Press
to answer the call.
Note: When your phone is off, in an active PCS Vision Connection, or on a
PCS Ready Link call, incoming calls go directly to voicemail.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
22
EndingaCall
To disconnect a call when you are finished:
WiththeFlipopen:
ᮣ
Close the phone or press
.
WiththeFlipclosed:
ᮣ
Press and hold
.
Note: If the setting for Close Flip is not set to “end call,” closing the phone will not
end the call. (See “Setting the Open/Close Flip Option” on page 57.)
Tip: Time/Date is displayed when you press
while the phone is in use.
Using the Speakerphone
The speakerphone feature lets you hear audio through the speaker
and talk without holding the phone. When the speakerphone is
activated, use the volume control keys on the side of the phone to
adjust the volume.
Toturnthespeakerphoneonduringacall:
ᮣ
Press
– or –
.
Press Options (right softkey), highlight SpeakerOn, and press
.
.
Toturnthespeakerphoneoffduringacall:
ᮣ
Press
– or –
.
Press Options (right softkey), highlight SpeakerOff, and press
Warning! Due to higher volume levels, do not place the phone near your ear
during speakerphone use.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
23
Changing the Ringer Volume
To change the ringer volume, press the Side Volume key when the
phone is open and in standby mode.
Note: To change the ringer volume from the main menu, see “Adjusting the
Phone’s Volume Settings” on page 41.
Adjusting Volume During a Conversation
When you need to adjust the receiver volume during a conversation,
use the side volume key, or press the navigation key up or down
while a call is in progress.
Muting a Call
There are times when it’s necessary to mute a call so that your caller
does not hear you or certain background noise.
TomuteacallwiththeFlipopen:
ᮣ
Press Options (right softkey), highlight Mute, and press
.
(When the phone is muted, “Mute” appears on the display.)
TounmuteacallwiththeFlipopen:
ᮣ
Press Options (right softkey), highlight Unmute, and press
.
TomuteacallwiththeFlipclosed:
ᮣ
Simply press
(side of the phone).
TounmuteacallwiththeFlipclosed:
ᮣ
Press
once again during a call.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
24
Missed Call Notification
When an incoming call is not answered, the Missed Call log is
displayed on your screen.
TodisplaytheMissedCallentry:
ᮣ
Press View (left softkey). (To call an entry, highlight the entry
you want to call and press
or
.)
Calling Emergency Numbers
You can place calls to 911 (dial
and press
),
even if your phone is locked or your account is restricted. Once you
dial the numbers, your phone will enter Emergency mode.
Press Options (right softkey) to display the options. To select an option,
highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
MyPhone# to display your phone number.
ⅷ
ⅷ
SpeakerOn to activate speakerphone mode. (If you are in
speakerphone mode, the option will appear as SpeakerOff to
deactivate.)
UnlockPhone to unlock your phone (appears only if the phone is
locked).
ToexitEmergencymode:
1. Press
.
2. Press Options (right softkey) to display the options.
Ⅲ
Call911 to call 911.
Ⅲ
Call911:Speaker to call 911 in speakerphone mode.
Ⅲ
MyPhone# to display your phone number.
Ⅲ
ExitEmergency to exit Emergency mode.
3. Highlight ExitEmergency and press
.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
25
In-Call Options
During a call, your phone displays menu options when you press
Options (right softkey).
To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
Flash to answer an incoming Call Waiting call or to connect a third
party during Three-Way Calling.
ⅷ
ⅷ
Mute or Unmute
Select Mute to mute your phone’s microphone. Select Unmute to
reactivate the microphone.
SpeakerOn or SpeakerOff to activate or deactivate speakerphone
mode. You can adjust the speakerphone volume using the Side
Volume key.
Warning! Due to higher volume levels, do not place the phone near your ear
during speakerphone use.
ⅷ
Three-WayCall to call a third party.
ⅷ
CallHistory to access the Call History menu. (See “Managing Call
History” on page 83.)
ⅷ
Contacts to access the Contacts menu. (See “Using the Contacts
Directory” on page 88.)
ⅷ
Messaging to access the Messaging menu. (See “PCS Messaging”
on page 193.)
ⅷ
Settings to access the Settings menu. (See “Controlling Your
Phone’s Settings” on page 35.)
ⅷ
Tools/Extras to access the Tools/Extras menu. (See “Personal
Organizer” on page 99.)
ⅷ
VoiceServices to access the Voice Services menu. (See “Using
Your Phone’s Voice Services” on page 123.)
Note: The Flash menu appears only for Call Waiting and Three-Way Calling.
The Mute menu does not appear during a 911 call. The Three-Way Call menu
does not appear in Roaming areas.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
26
End-of-Call Options
To display the following options, press Options (right softkey) within
10 seconds after disconnecting a call.
To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
CallAgain to dial the phone number.
ⅷ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone mode.
ⅷ
SavePhone# to save the phone number in your Contacts list.
GotoPhoneBook appears when the number is already in your
Contacts list. (See “Saving a Phone Number” below.)
Note: The End-of-Call options are not displayed for calls identified as No ID or
Restricted.
Saving a Phone Number
Your PCS Vision Phone can store up to 500 phone numbers in up to
300 Contacts entries (an entry may contain up to seven numbers).
Each entry’s name can contain 16 characters. Your phone
automatically sorts the Contacts entries alphabetically. (For more
information, see Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory on page 88.)
Tosaveanumberfromstandbymode:
1. Enter a phone number.
2. Press Options (right softkey).
3. Highlight SavePhone# and press
4. Select a label by highlighting Mobile, Home, Work, Pager, Fax,
Other, or NoLabel and press
5. Enter a name and press
.
.
.
If you have already stored entries in the Contacts list, you are
prompted to select the following entry modes:
Ⅲ
NewName to enter a new name.
Ⅲ
FromPh. Book to select a name from the Contacts entry list.
6. Press Save (left softkey).
After you have saved the number, the new Contacts entry is
displayed. (See “Contacts List Entry Options” on page 92.)
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
27
Finding a Phone Number
You can search Contacts list entries for phone numbers that contain a
specific string of numbers.
Tofindaphonenumber:
1. Enter the last four or more digits of the number and press
Options (right softkey). The more numbers you enter, the more
specific the search becomes.
2. Highlight Find and press . (The Contacts entry that ends with
the digits you entered appears.)
3. Highlight your desired entry.
Ⅲ
Press
Press
to display the entry details.
or to dial.
Ⅲ
Dialing and Saving Phone NumbersWith Pauses
You can dial or save phone numbers with pauses for use with
automated systems, such as voicemail or credit card billing numbers.
There are two types of pauses available on your phone:
ⅷ
HardPause sends the next set of numbers when you press
.
ⅷ
2-Sec. Pause automatically sends the next set of numbers after
two seconds.
Note: You can have multiple pauses in a phone number and combine 2-second
and hard pauses.
Todialorsavephonenumberswithpauses:
1. Enter the phone number and press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight either HardPause or 2-Sec. Pause and press
.
(Hard pauses are displayed as a “H” and 2-second pauses as a “T”.)
3. Enter additional numbers (for example, a passcode or an
extension).
4. To dial the number, press
with a hard pause, press
– or –
or
. (When dialing a number
to send the next set of numbers.)
To save the number in your Contacts list, press Options (right
softkey), highlight SavePhone#, and press
.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
28
Dialing From the Contacts Directory
TodialdirectlyfromaContactsentry:
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
Shortcut: Press the navigation key right to list entries.
4. Use your navigation key to scroll through the Contacts list,
highlight your desired entry, and press
.
5. Highlight the number you want to call.
6. Press Options (right softkey) for the menu options.
7. Highlight Call or Call:SpeakerOn and press to place a call.
, or Call (left softkey) during
Tip: You can also place a call by pressing
step 5 above.
,
Note: The icons next to each entry represent the Contacts labels (for example,
Mobile, Home, Work, etc.). A triangle next to an icon means there is another
number for the entry. Press the navigation key right or left to select the desired
label/number.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
29
Using Speed Dialing
With this feature, you can dial your favorite entries using one key press
for locations 2-9. (See “Assigning Speed Dial Numbers” on page 94.)
Tousespeeddialforvoicecalls:
ᮣ
From standby mode, press and hold the appropriate key for
approximately two seconds.
– or –
ᮣ
From standby mode, press the appropriate key and
press
or
.
The display confirms that the number has been dialed when it shows
“Connecting...”.
TousespeeddialforPCSReadyLinkcalls:
ᮣ
From standby mode, press the appropriate key then press and
hold
. (See “Setting Speed Dialing for PCS Ready Link
Entries” on page 148.)
The display confirms that the number has been dialed when it shows
“R-Link calling...”.
Note: Speed dialing is not available when you are roaming; when you are
roaming off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, you must always dial using
eleven digits (1 + area code + number).
Using Abbreviated Dialing
Abbreviated Dialing is another form of speed dialing. It allows you to
dial a number by entering just the last four digits of any number in
your Contacts directory. The Abbreviated Dialing option becomes
available when you enter the last four digits of a phone number and
press Options (right softkey).
ToplaceacallusingAbbreviatedDialing:
1. Dial the last four digits of a contact’s phone number.
2. Press Options (right softkey) to display the dialing options.
3. Highlight Abbrev. Dial and press
,
, or
.
Note: If there are two or more matched numbers in your Contacts list, the
number that comes first alphabetically will be dialed. If there is no matched
number, your phone dials the number you set for abbreviated dial with the last
4-digits you entered. (See “Setting Abbreviated Dialing” on page 59.)
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
30
EnteringText
Selecting a Character Input Mode
Your PCS Vision Phone provides convenient ways to enter words,
letters, punctuation, and numbers whenever you are prompted to
enter text (for example, when adding a Contacts entry or when
sending email messages).
Tochangethecharacterinputmode:
1. When you display a screen where you can enter text, press
Mode (right softkey).
2. Select a character input mode:
Ⅲ
T9Word to enter characters using predictive
T9 Text Input (see next page).
Ⅲ
Alphabet to enter characters by tapping the keypad
(see page 33).
Ⅲ
SYMBOL to enter symbols (see page 34).
Ⅲ
NUMBER to enter numbers (see page 34).
Ⅲ
PRESETSUFFIX to enter a preset suffix (see page 34).
Ⅲ
SMILEYS to enter “emoticons” (see page 34).
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
31
Entering Characters Using T9Text Input
T9 Text Input lets you enter text in your PCS Vision Phone by
pressing keys just once per letter. (To select the T9Word mode when
entering text, see “Selecting a Character Input Mode” on the
previous page.)
T9 Text Input analyzes the letters you enter using an intuitive word
database and creates a suitable word. (The word may change as you
enter more letters.) If the word you want does not display after you
have entered all the letters, press
to scroll through additional
word selections. To accept a word and insert a space, press
.
If you make a mistake, press to erase a single character. Press and
hold to delete an entire entry.
AddingaWordtotheT9Database
If a word you want to enter does not display as an option when you
are using T9 Text Input, you can add it to the database.
ToaddawordtotheT9TextInputdatabase:
1. Select the Alphabet input mode. (See “Selecting a Character
Input Mode” on the previous page.)
2. Enter the word using multi-tap text entry. (See “Entering
Characters by Tapping the Keypad” on the next page.)
3. Press Mode (right softkey), highlight T9Word, and press
.
(The word will appear as an option the next time you scroll
through options during T9 Text Input.)
For more information about T9 Text Input, visit the Tegic Website at
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
32
Entering Characters byTapping the Keypad
To enter characters by tapping the keypad, select the Alphabet mode
(see “Selecting a Character Input Mode” on page 31). Press the
corresponding key repeatedly until the desired character appears.
By default, the first letter of an entry is capitalized and following
letters are lowercase.
Characters scroll in the following order:
English Sequence
Key
Upper Case
Lower Case
.,@ 1 ? ! # /
*
A B C 2
a b c 2
D E F 3
G H I 4
J K L 5
M N O 6
P Q R S 7
T U V 8
W XY Z 9
0
d e f 3
g h i 4
j k l 5
m n o 6
p q r s 7
t u v 8
w x y z 9
Space
Unshifted One-character- shifted Caps Lock
In Spanish mode, characters scroll in the following order:
Spanish Sequence
Key
Upper Case
Lower Case
.,@ 1 ¿ ? ¡ ! # /
*
A Á B C 2
a á b c 2
D E É F 3
G H I Í 4
J K L 5
d e é f 3
g h i í 4
j k l 5
M N Ñ O Ó 6
P Q R S 7
T U Ú Ü V 8
W XY Z 9
0
m n ñ o ó 6
p q r s 7
t u ú ü v 8
w x y z 9
Space
Unshifted One-character- shifted Caps Lock
(See page 63 for changing to Spanish language mode.)
After a character is entered, the cursor automatically advances to the
next space after two seconds or when you enter a character on a
different key.
Tip: The beginning of the word after the space is changed to upper/lower case
depending on shift mode. You can change the shift mode by pressing
.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
33
Entering Symbols,Numbers,Preset Suffixes,and
Smileys
Toentersymbols:
1. In a text entry field, press Mode (right softkey).
2. Highlight SYMBOL and press
.
3. Highlight the line that includes your desired symbol.
4. Press the corresponding key (1-8) with each symbol.
– or –
Highlight your desired symbol by using the navigation key and
press
.
Toenternumbers:
1. In a text entry field, press Mode (right softkey).
2. Highlight NUMBER and press
.
3. Press the corresponding number key to enter the number.
Shortcut: Press and hold the corresponding number key to enter the number
directly in alphabet mode or T9 mode.
Toenterpresetsuffixes:
The Preset Suffix menu is a preprogrammed list of common prefixes,
suffixes, and punctuation strings (for example, “www.”, “.com”, and
“//”) designed to make text entry easier and more efficient.
1. In a text entry field, press Mode (right softkey).
2. Highlight PRESETSUFFIX and press
3. Highlight your desired word by using the navigation key and
press
.
.
Toenter“emoticons”(smileys):
1. In a text entry field, press Mode (right softkey).
2. Highlight SMILEYS and press
.
3. Highlight the line that includes your desired smiley.
4. Press the corresponding key (1-4) with each smiley.
– or –
Highlight your desired smiley by using the navigation key and
press
.
Note: Preset Suffix and Smileys do not apply in PCS Ready Link mode.
Section 2A: Your PCS Vision Phone – The Basics
34
Section 2B
Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ SoundSettings
DisplaySettings
LocationSettings
AirplaneMode
TTYUseWithPCSServiceFromSprint
PhoneSetupOptions
UsingthemenuoptionsavailableonyourPCSVisionPhone, youcan
customizeyourphonetosound, look, andoperatejustthewayyouwantitto.
This section describes how you can change your phone’s settings to
best suit your needs. Take a few moments to review these options and
to adjust or add settings that are right for you.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
35
Sound Settings
Ringer Types
Ringer types help you identify incoming calls and messages. You can
assign ringer types to individual Contacts entries, types of calls, and
types of messages.
ⅷ
PreprogrammedRingers include a variety of standard ringer types
and familiar music.
ⅷ
VibratingRinger alerts you to calls or messages without
disturbing others.
ⅷ
DownloadedRingerscan be downloaded right to your phone.
(See “Downloading Premium Services Content” on page 208 and
“Ringers” on page 212.)
SelectingRingerTypesforVoiceCalls
Your PCS Vision Phone provides a variety of ringer options that allow
you to customize your ringer and volume settings. These options
allow you to identify incoming calls by the ringer.
Toselectaringertypeforvoicecalls:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
.
5. Select VoiceCalls and press
.
6. Select the menu under WithCallerID or NoCallerID and press
.
7. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ringer&Voice to notify you with Ringer & Voice for voice calls.
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 115).
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
36
Toselectadistinctiveringerforvoicecallswhileroaming:
1. Follow steps 1-5 on the previous page.
2. Select the menu under Roaming and press
.
3. Select Distinctive and press
.
Ⅲ
To confirm the ringer, press Play (right softkey).
Ⅲ
If you want to deactivate this feature, select Normal during
step 3 above.
SelectingRingerTypesforPCSReadyLinkCalls
ToselectaringertypeforPCSReadyLinkcalls:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
5. Select ReadyLinkCalls and press
6. Select the menu under ReadyLinkCalls and press
.
.
.
7. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
37
SelectingRingerTypesforMissedPCSReadyLinkCalls
ToselectaringertypeforMissedPCSReadyLinkcalls:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
5. Select R-LinkMissed and press
6. Select the menu under R-LinkMissed and press
.
.
.
7. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
SelectingRingerTypesforVoicemail
Toselectaringertypeforvoicemail:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
.
5. Select Voicemail and press
.
6. Select the menu under Voicemail and press
.
7. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
VoiceRinger to notify you with Voice for voicemail.
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 115).
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
38
SelectingRingerTypesforMessages
Toselectaringertypeformessages:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
.
5. Select Messaging and press
.
6. Select the menu under Messaging and press
.
7. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
VoiceRinger to notify you with Voice for Messages.
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 115).
SelectingRingerTypesforCalendar
Toselectaringertypeforcalendar:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
.
5. Select Calendar and press
.
6. Select the menu under Calendar and press
.
7. Select your desired type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
VoiceRinger to notify you with Voice for calendar events.
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 115).
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
39
Selecting a Tone Length
Longer tone lengths may be better for tone recognition when dialing
voicemail or other automated systems.
Toselectatonelength:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Sounds and press
4. Select Others and press
.
.
.
5. Select the menu under ToneLength and press
6. Select Short or Long and press
.
.
Setting a Start-up/Power-offTone
1. Follow steps 1-4 in “Selecting a Tone Length.”
2. Select the menu under Start-upTone or Power-offTone and
press
.
3. Select your desired tone and press
.
Ⅲ
Tone to select a tone. Scroll through available tones to hear
previews.
Ⅲ
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select a tone to
download (see page 115).
Tip: You can set the volume of Start-up Tone and Power-off Tone. See next page.
Using Voice Prompt
This feature allows you to hear voice prompts at Voice Memo,
Screen Call setting, Voice Dial, etc. (default setting is On).
Todeactivatethisfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Sounds and press
4. Select Others and press
.
.
.
5. Select the menu under VoicePrompt and press
6. Select Off and press
.
.
Tip: When ringer volume is set to “Silence All,” voice prompts cannot be heard.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
40
Adjusting the Phone’s Volume Settings
You can adjust your phone’s volume settings to suit your needs and
your environment.
Toadjusttheringer,start-up/power-off,orkeybeepvolume:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select Ringer/KeyVol. and press
.
5. Select the item you wish to change and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerVolume to adjust Ringer tone volume.
Ⅲ
Start-up/Pw-off to adjust Start-up/Power-off tone volume.
Ⅲ
KeyBeep to adjust Key Beep tone volume.
6. Adjust a volume level by pressing the navigation key up or down
and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerOff to set the Voice Call ringer volume to off. (Only
appears in Ringer Volume setting.)
Ⅲ
SilenceAll to set all the ringer volumes settings to off.
(Only appears in Ringer Volume setting. See “Silence All” on
page 43.)
Toadjusttheearpieceorspeakervolume:
1. Follow steps 1-3 above.
2. Select ReceiverVol. and press
3. Select either Earpiece or Speaker and press
4. Adjust a volume level by pressing the navigation key up or down
and press
.
.
.
Tip: You can adjust the ringer volume in standby mode (or the earpiece volume
during a call) by using the Side Volume key.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
41
Alert Notification
Your PCS Phone can alert you with an audible tone when you change
service areas, once a minute during a voice call, for incoming or
missed PCS Ready Link calls, or when a call has been connected.
ⅷ
Service sets alert on or off for network services parameter
changes.
ⅷ
ReadyLinkCalls sets an alert to notify you of PCS Ready Link calls.
ⅷ
R-LinkMissed sets an alert to notify you of missed PCS Ready Link
calls.
ⅷ
Voicemail sets an alert to notify you of voice messages.
ⅷ
Messaging sets an alert to notify you of text messages.
ⅷ
MinuteBeep sets a minute reminder that beeps ten seconds before
the end of each minute during a call.
ⅷ
SignalFade sets an alert to notify you when your phone loses a
signal during a call.
Tosetalerts:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Sounds and press
4. Select Alerts and press
.
.
.
5. Select your desired option and press
.
6. If you selected Service, MinuteBeep, or SignalFade, select On and
press . If you selected ReadyLinkCalls, R-LinkMissed,
Voicemail, or Messaging, select Once or RepeatAlert and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 6 above.
Tip: Repeat Alert sounds an alert every two minutes for twenty minutes.
Tip: To set alerts for PCS Ready Link calls, see “Setting an Alert Notification for
PCS Ready Link Calls” on page 150 for details.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
42
SilenceAll
There may be times when you need to silence your phone entirely.
The phone’s Silence All option allows you to mute all sounds without
turning your phone off.
ToactivateSilenceAll:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select Ringer/KeyVol. and press
.
5. Select RingerVolume and press
.
6. Press the navigation key down until SilenceAll appears on the
display and press
.
Tip: When Ringer Volume is set as Silence All, other items are changed to Off and
cannot be highlighted.
TodeactivateSilenceAll:
ᮣ
Press the volume key up repeatedly to select a desired
volume level.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
43
Display Settings
Changing theText Greeting
The text greeting can be up to fifteen characters and is displayed on
your phone’s screen in standby mode. You may choose to display a
custom greeting or you may display “Sprint” on the phone’s screen.
Todisplayorchangeyourcustomgreeting:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Display and press
4. Select Greeting and press
.
.
.
5. Select Custom and press
.
Ⅲ
You can customize the greeting by entering a personalized
greeting. (See “Entering Text” on page 31.)
6. Press
.
Todisplaythedefaultgreeting(“Sprint”):
1. Follow steps 1-4 above.
2. Select Default and press
.
Ⅲ
When you are in PCS Ready Link mode, “Ready Link”
appears on the display instead of “Sprint.”
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
44
Changing the BacklightTime Length
The backlight setting lets you select how long the display screen and
keypad are backlit after any key press is made.
TochangetheMainLCDorSubLCDbacklightsetting:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Display and press
4. Select Backlight and press
.
.
.
5. Select MainLCD or SubLCD and press
.
6. Select AlwaysOn, AlwaysOff, or your defined time length and
press
.
Ⅲ
AlwaysOff always turns the backlight off.
Ⅲ
AlwaysOn keeps the backlight on indefinitely.
Note: The Always On setting returns to the previous value the next time you turn
on the phone.
TochangetheKeypadbacklightsetting:
1. Select Key during step 5 above, and press
.
2. Select AlwaysOff or your defined time length and press
.
Note: Long backlight settings affect the battery’s talk and standby times.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
45
Changing the Display ScreenAnimation
Your new PCS Vision Phone offers options for what you see on the
display screen during various phone functions.
Tochangethedisplayanimation:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Display and press
4. Select Animation and press
.
.
.
5. Select Standby, OutgoingCalls, or ServiceSearch, and press
6. Select the menu under the item and press
.
.
7. Select your desired option and press
.
Ⅲ
Press Preview (right softkey) to see a sample display.
Ⅲ
For standby, you will also set the animation starting time.
Select the option under after and press , then highlight
your desired setting time and press
.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 116).
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 7 above.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
46
Changing the Display for Incoming Calls
You can set the color or downloaded image to be shown on the
Incoming Calls display.
Tosetyourincomingcallsdisplay:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select IncomingCalls and press
.
5. Select the menu under IncomingCalls and press
.
6. Select your desired color or downloaded image and press
.
Ⅲ
Preset to select the pre-programmed color image.
Ⅲ
Off to turn the image type off.
Ⅲ
Downloads to set a downloaded image saved in your phone.
Ⅲ
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 116).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
InCamera to set a picture saved in your In Camera folder.
SavedtoPh. to set a picture saved in your Saved to Phone
folder.
Ⅲ
Press Preview (right softkey) during step 6 above to see an
example display. Press the right softkey to switch between
Main/Sub LCD’s display preview.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
47
Changing the Display for Area Name
This feature enables you to show the area of the phone number you
are calling or are called from when the number is not registered in
your Contacts list. For example, a call to or from 213-555-5555 will
display “California.”
Tosetyourareanamedisplay:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select MatchAreaCode and press
.
5. Select On or Off and press
.
Ⅲ
This feature is available only when the phone number is
10 digits, or 11 digits beginning with 1 and matches an
area code.
Ⅲ
The area name will not be displayed for numbers in your
Contacts list or for incoming calls when an Animation
Ringer is assigned.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
48
Changing the Display for Standby Mode
This feature enables you to select a variety of items to display in
standby mode.
Tosetyourstandbydisplay:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select StandbyDisplay and press
.
5. Select your desired item and press
.
Ⅲ
ScreenSaver selects the screen saver to display.
Calendar displays the Calendar.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
DigitalClock displays the local time in digital view.
AnalogClock displays the local time in analog view.
WorldClock displays the time of the selected city or country
along with the local time. You can scroll the World Clock list
by pressing the navigation key right or left. Press Summer
(left softkey) or Standard (right softkey) to change between
Daylight Savings and standard time if applicable. (The “
”
icon indicates Daylight Savings time.)
Tip: You can also display the World Clock from Tools/Extras menu. (See “Using
the World Clock” on page 112.)
Ⅲ
Default returns the standby display to its default setting.
6. Press
to save the setting to follow each system prompt or
when confirming the preview display.
Tip: In an area without service, Screen Saver, Calendar, Digital Clock,
Analog Clock, or World Clock cannot be shown on the standby display.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
49
Changing the Screen Saver
Your new PCS Phone offers you the option of displaying a screen
saver while in standby mode.
Toassignascreensaver:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select StandbyDisplay and press
.
5. Select ScreenSaver and press
.
6. Select the menu under ScreenSaver and press
.
7. Select your desired screen saver and press
.
Ⅲ
Preset to select a pre-installed screen saver.
Ⅲ
Downloads to set a downloaded image saved in your phone.
Ⅲ
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download (see page 116).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
InCamera to set a picture saved in your In Camera folder.
SavedtoPh. to set a picture saved in your Saved to Phone
folder.
8. Press Save (left softkey) to save the screen saver.
Ⅲ
To see a display preview of an image, press Preview (right
softkey) during step 7 above. Press the right softkey to
switch between Main/Sub LCD’s display preview.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
50
Changing the Display for My Buddy
This feature enables you to see a funny animation for 30 seconds on
the Main LCD by opening the flip.
ToactivateordeactivateMyBuddy:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Display and press
4. Select MyBuddy and press
.
.
.
5. Select On or Off and press
.
Ⅲ
Press Preview (right softkey) during step 5 above to see a
display preview. Press the right softkey to switch between
Main/Sub LCD’s display preview.
Ⅲ
Press Info (left softkey) to see My Buddy information.
Changing the Background
You can customize your phone display’s appearance by selecting a
color scheme to reflect your personality.
Tochangethedisplay’sbackground:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select Background and press
.
5. Select MainLCD or SubLCD and press
.
6. Select your desired color and press
.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
51
Changing the Font Size
You can change the font size settings for the message notification and
browser.
Tochangethefontsize:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Display and press
4. Select FontSize and press
.
.
.
5. Select either Message or Browser and press
.
6. Select your desired font size.
Ⅲ
Press Preview (right softkey) to display a font size example.
7. Press
to set the selected font.
Tip: From the font example display, select your desired font size by pressing the
navigation key right or left.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
52
Location Settings
Your PCS Vision Phone is equipped with a Location feature for use in
connection with location-based services that may be available
in the future.
The Location feature allows the network to detect your position.
Turning Location off will hide your location from everyone
except 911.
Note: Even if the Location feature is enabled, no service may use your location
without your express permission.
Toenableyourphone’sLocationfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Location and press
.
4. You will see a message on the display. Press
or OK (left
softkey) to continue.
Ⅲ
Press the navigation key down to read the whole message.
5. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 5 above.
When the Location feature is on, your phone’s standby screen will
display the
display.
icon. When Location is turned off, the
icon will
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
53
Airplane Mode
Airplane Mode allows you to use many of your phone’s features, such
as Games, Voice Memos, etc., when you are in an airplane or in any
other area where making or receiving calls or data is prohibited.
When your phone is in Airplane Mode, it cannot send or receive any
calls or access online information.
TosetyourphonetoAirplaneMode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select AirplaneMode and press
.
5. You will see a message on the display. Press
or OK (left
softkey) to continue.
Ⅲ
Press Cancel (right softkey) to return to previous menu.
6. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 6.
While in Airplane Mode, your phone’s standby screen will display
“Phone Off.”
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
54
TTY UseWith PCS Service From Sprint
A TTY (also known as a TDD or Text Telephone) is a
telecommunications device that allows people who are deaf or hard
of hearing, or who have speech or language disabilities, to
communicate by telephone.
Your phone is compatible with select TTY devices. Please check with
the manufacturer of your TTY device to ensure that it supports digital
wireless transmission. Your phone and TTY device will connect via a
special cable that plugs into your phone’s headset jack. If this cable
was not provided with your TTY device, contact your TTY device
manufacturer to purchase the connector cable.
When establishing your PCS Service, please call PCS Customer
Solutions via the state Telecommunications Relay Service (TRS) by
first dialing
. Then provide the state TRS with
this number: 866-727-4889.
ToturnTTY modeonoroff:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Others and press
.
.
4. Select TTY and press . (You will see a message on the display.)
5. Press or OK (left softkey) to continue.
6. Select Enable or Disable and press
.
Note: When you connect TTY devices, your phone will display in TTY mode.
If TTY mode is enabled, the audio quality of non-TTY devices connected to the
headset jack may be impaired.
IMPORTANT NOTICE: 911 Emergency Calling
Sprint recommends that TTY users make Emergency calls by other means,
including Telecommunications Relay Services (TRS), analog cellular, and
landline communications. Wireless TTY calls to 911 may be corrupted when
received by public safety answering points (PSAPs) rendering some
communications unintelligible. The problem encountered appears related to TTY
equipment or software used by PSAPs. This matter has been brought to the
attention of the FCC, and the wireless industry and PSAP community are
currently working to resolve this.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
55
Phone Setup Options
Shortcut
Your phone offers you the option of assigning a shortcut key to a
favorite or often-used function. Pressing the navigation key to the left
in standby mode will launch your personally designated shortcut.
Toassignyourshortcutkey:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select MyShortcut and press
.
5. Select the menu under MyShortcut and press
.
6. Select your desired menu option and press
.
Ⅲ
Press Info (right softkey) during step 5 above to see an
information screen.
AutoAnswer Mode
You may set your phone to automatically pick up incoming calls
when connected to an optional hands-free car kit and headset (sold
separately).
TosetAutoAnswermode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select AutoAnswer and press
.
5. Select CarKit/Headset or SpeakerPhone and press
.
6. Select either 5Seconds or 15Seconds and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 6 above.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
56
Setting the Open/Close Flip Option
This feature enables you to answer an incoming call by opening the
flip or to end a call by closing the flip.
ToactivatetheOpenFlipfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select Open/CloseFlip and press
5. Select Open and press
.
.
6. Select AnswerCall and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select NoAction during step 6.
ToactivatetheCloseFlipfeature:
1. Follow steps 1-4 above.
2. Select Close and press . (You will see a message on the display.)
3. Press OK (left softkey) to continue.
4. Select EndCall and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Mute during step 4.
Note: This feature does not apply when you are using the speakerphone,
a headset, or a car kit.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
57
Setting Any KeyAnswer
This feature allows you to answer incoming calls by pressing
any key (except
,
,
,
,
,
, Side Camera Key,
Softkey [right], or Navigation Key).
Toactivatethisfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select AnyKeyAnswer and press
.
5. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 5 above.
Setting the Side Key Guard
This feature enables you to lock your side keys (Ready Link [Memo]
button, Side Volume key, Side Call key, and Side Camera key) while
the flip is closed.
Toactivatethisfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select SideKeyGuard and press
.
5. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
KeyGuard appears on the Sub LCD when you press any side
key while the flip is closed.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 5 above.
Note: This feature does not apply when the flip is open.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
58
Setting Abbreviated Dialing
Abbreviated Dialing is another form of speed dialing. It allows you to
dial a number by entering just the last four digits of any number in
your Contacts Directory. If the last four digits you enter do not match
any stored Contacts entry, the digits are automatically prepended
with the area code and prefix you specify.
Toactivatethisfeature:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select Abbrev. Dial and press
5. Select Enable and press
.
.
6. Enter a six-digit number (area code and prefix) and press
or
OK (left softkey).
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, highlight Disable during step 5
above.
Tip: If you enter fewer than 6 digits, the display shows a warning message.
(See “Using Abbreviated Dialing” on page 30.)
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
59
Headset Mode
This feature allows you hands-free phone use. Set the headset mode
to Voice Call or Ready Link and press the Turbo Button (the operation
button) on the headset to activate useful functions.
Tosetheadsetmode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select HeadsetMode and press
.
5. Select VoiceCall or ReadyLink and press
.
Ⅲ
Press Info (right softkey) during step 5 above to see the
Headset Mode information screen.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 5 above.
Usingthephonewithheadsetmodeactivated:
ⅷ
VoiceCall: Press the Turbo Button to activate Voice dial. Press
twice to redial the last call. Press and hold the button to record a
Voice Memo.
ⅷ
ReadyLink: Press and hold the Turbo Button to redial the last
PCS Ready Link call.
Note: If your headset doesn’t have a Turbo Button, set headset mode to Off.
Sleep Mode
This feature helps conserve your battery power by restricting the
display.
Tosetsleepmode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select SleepMode and press
.
5. Select MainLCD or SubLCD and press
.
.
6. Select your desired option and press
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, highlight Off during step 6 above.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
60
Setting Message Notification
You can see a pop-up message notification when you receive a text
message or Voicemail while you are in PCS Vision applications,
browser mode, or Voice Calls.
Tosetmessagenotification:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Messaging and press
.
4. Select DisplayPop-up and press
.
5. Highlight the box and press
to check/uncheck the box next
to Games/Apps, Browser, or VoiceCalls.
6. Press Save (left softkey).
Ⅲ
Press Info (right softkey) during step 5 above to see the
Messages information.
Editing Preset Messages
Your phone can store pre-set messages for use with text messaging
and Picture Mail. You can edit your phone’s default preset messages
through the Settings menu. (For more information on using preset
messages, see page 195.)
Toedityourphone’spresetmessages:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Messaging and press
.
4. Select PresetMsgs and press
5. Select the message you want to edit and press
6. Use your keypad to edit the message and press OK (left softkey)
.
.
or
to save your changes. (“Preset Msg Saved” will display.)
Ⅲ
To reset all messages, press Options (right softkey), select
ResetAllMsgs, and press
during step 5 above.
Note: For information on editing text, see “Entering Text” on page 31.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
61
Setting a Callback Number
With this feature, you can notify your recipients of your callback
number with the text message.
Tosetthecallbacknumber:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Messaging and press
.
4. Select SendCallback# and press
.
5. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
None to send no callback number.
Ⅲ
MyPhone# to send your phone number.
Ⅲ
Other to send a specific callback number. To set a number,
enter a phone number and press
.
Setting the CurrentTime
Tosetthecurrenttimewhenyouareroaminginanareawithno
digitalnetwork:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Others and press
.
4. Select SetTime/Date and press
.
5. Set the current time and date and press
.
Note: This feature is only available when you are in an area with no digital
network available.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
62
Display Language
You can choose to display your PCS Phone’s onscreen menus in
English or in Spanish.
Toassignalanguageforthephone’sdisplay:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Others and press
4. Select Language and press
.
.
.
5. Select English or Español and press
.
Using the Mini Flashlight
This function allows you to use the phone’s camera flash as a
miniature flashlight. To use this function, your phone must be in
standby mode with the Side Key Guard unlocked. (See page 58 for
unlocking the Side Key Guard.)
Tousetheminiflashlight:
ᮣ
With the phone closed and in standby mode, press and hold the
Side Volume key (
). (The light flashes for 8 seconds.)
Note: This function doesn’t apply when a Missed Call or Notification is displayed.
Section 2B: Controlling Your Phone’s Settings
63
Section 2C
Setting Your Phone’s Security
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ AccessingtheSecurityMenu
UsingYourPhone’sLockFeature
RestrictingCalls
UsingSpecialNumbers
ErasingtheContactsDirectory
ErasingAllDownloads
ResettingYourPicturesAccount
ResettingYourPhone
ResettingandLockingYourPhoneThroughSMS
SM
SecurityFeaturesforPCSVision
ByusingthesecuritysettingsonyourPCSVisionPhone, youreceive
peaceofmindwithoutsacrificingflexibility. This section will
familiarize you with your phone’s security settings. With several
options available, you can customize your phone to meet your
personal needs.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
64
Accessing the Security Menu
All of your phone’s security settings are available through the
Security menu. You must enter your lock code to view the
Security menu.
ToaccesstheSecuritymenu:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
.
3. Select Security and press
4. Enter your lock code. (The Security menu is displayed.)
Tip: If you can’t recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your
Social Security number or PCS Phone Number or try 0000. If none of these work,
call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
65
UsingYour Phone’s Lock Feature
LockingYour Phone
When your phone is locked, you can only receive incoming calls or
make calls to 911, PCS Customer Solutions, or special numbers.
Tolockyourphone:
1. From the Security menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on
the previous page), select LockPhone and press
.
2. Highlight LockNow or OnPower-up and press
.
3. Depending on your preference, highlight either FullLock or
Excp. Incom.Calls and press
.
Ⅲ
FullLock: No phone calls can be made, except for
Emergency number,
(PCS Customer Solutions),
or special numbers. No phone calls can be received except
for special numbers.
Ⅲ
Excp. Incom.Calls: No phone calls can be made, except for
Emergency number,
(PCS Customer Solutions),
or special numbers, but all incoming calls can be received.
Tip: If you want to cancel the “On Power-up” setting before turning the phone off,
select Unlocked during step 2 above.
UnlockingYour Phone
Tounlockyourphone:
1. Press Unlock (left softkey).
2. Enter your lock code. (Your phone will unlock and return to
standby mode.)
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
66
Locking the Pictures Menu
With this feature,you must enter your lock code when you access the
Pictures menu.
TolockthePicturesmenu:
1. From the Security Menu (see “Accessing the Security Menu” on
page 65), select LockPicture and press
.
2. Select LockNow and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Unlocked during step 2
above.
Changing the Lock Code
Tochangeyourlockcode:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select Others and press
.
2. Select ChangeLock and press
.
3. Enter a new lock code, (“1234” for example) under NewCode.
4. Reenter the new code under ReenterCode.
Calling in Lock Mode
You can place calls to 911, PCS Customer Solutions, and to your
special numbers when in lock mode. (For information on special
numbers, see “Using Special Numbers” on page 69.)
Toplaceanoutgoingcallinlockmode:
ᮣ
To call an Emergency number, special number, or PCS Customer
Solutions, enter the phone number and press
.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
67
Restricting Calls
There may be occasions when you want to limit the numbers your
phone can call or from which it can receive calls. You can use the
Restrict Calls setting to do just that. (The Restrict Calls setting does
not apply to 911 or PCS Customer Solutions.)
Torestrictcalls:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select Others and press
2. Select LimitUse and press
3. Select OutgoingCalls or IncomingCalls and press
.
.
.
4. Select your desired option and press
.
Ⅲ
AllowAll lets you make or receive all calls.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
PhoneBookOnly lets you make or receive calls to or from
Contacts entries, Voicemail, or special numbers only.
Special#sOnly lets you make or receive calls to or from three
special numbers only. (See “Using Special Numbers” on the
next page.)
Note: Restricted incoming calls are forwarded to voicemail.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
68
Using Special Numbers
Special numbers are important numbers that you have designated as
being “always available.” You can call and receive calls from special
numbers even if your phone is locked.
You can save 3 special numbers in addition to your Contacts entries
(the same number may be in both directories).
Toaddorreplaceaspecialnumber:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select Others and press
2. Select Special#s and press
3. Select the box under an entry number and press
.
.
.
4. Enter your desired phone number and press
.
– or –
Press Options (right softkey), select FromPhoneBook or
Voicemail, and press
.
5. When you have finished entering or changing your special
numbers, press Done (left softkey).
Toinsertpausesintoaspecialnumber:
1. From step 4 above, enter the phone number and press Options
(right softkey) for the options.
2. Highlight HardPause, 2-Sec. Pause, or Hyphen and press
.
3. Finish entering the rest of the numbers and press
.
Erasing the Contacts Directory
You can quickly and easily erase all of the contents of your
Contacts Directory.
ToeraseallthenamesandphonenumbersinyourContactsDirectory:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select ErasePh. Book and press
2. If you’re sure you want to erase your Contacts, select Yes and
press
.
.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
69
ErasingAll Downloads
ToerasealldatadownloadedfromtheWeb:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select EraseDownload and press
.
2. If you’re sure you want to erase all data downloaded from the
Web, select Yes and press
.
Ⅲ
If you have assigned downloaded data, the function returns
to its default setting.
ResettingYour PicturesAccount
This option resets your authentication ID for your PCS Vision
pictures account.
Toresetyourpicturesaccount:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select ResetPictures and press
2. If you’re sure you want to reset your pictures account, select Yes
and press
.
.
After resetting, you are prompted to reenter the password when you
use Online Pictures.
Note: Your account will be locked if you enter wrong password 10 times after
resetting your acount. In this case, please contact Sprint PCS Customer Solutions.
ResettingYour Phone
Resetting the phone restores all the factory defaults, including the
ringer types and display settings. The Contacts, Call History,
Scheduler, and Messaging are not affected.
Toresetyourphone:
1. From the Security Menu display (see “Accessing the Security
Menu” on page 65), select ResetPhone and press
2. If you’re sure you want to reset your phone, select Yes and
press
.
.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
70
ResettingandLockingYourPhoneThroughSMS
When your phone is lost or stolen, you can erase your important
personal information (such as Contacts entries, call history, and
messages) and lock your phone by sending a special formatted SMS
message to your phone.
message to your phone (input your 10-digit PCS Phone Number
followed by “@messaging.sprintpcs.com.”) in the following format:
\ \ RESET **<Passcode>** RESET
<Passcode> – your defined passcode.
The default passcode is your phone’s 11-digit ESN
(Electronic Serial Number), which is written on the
package or on the phone itself.
The locked phone will display the following message:
“If found, please call PCS Customer Solutions 1-888-211-4727.”
Toactivatethisfeature,thefollowingpresettingisrequired:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Security and press
4. Enter your lock code.
5. Select Others and press
6. Select FoundMe and press
.
.
.
.
7. Select Reset/Lock and press
8. Select Enable and press
.
.
To unlock a phone that has been locked through SMS, bring the
phone to a Sprint Store.
ChangingthePasscode
TochangethepasscodeforthespecialformattedSMSmessages:
1. Follow steps 1-6 above.
2. Select ChgPasscode and press
.
3. Enter new passcode in the box under NewPasscode (11 digits).
4. Reenter the new passcode in the box under ReenterCode.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
71
SM
Security Features for PCSVision
Enabling and Disabling PCSVision Services
You can disable PCS Vision services without turning off your phone;
however, you will not have access to all PCS Vision services,
including Web and messaging. Disabling PCS Vision will avoid any
charges associated with PCS Vision services. While signed out, you
can still place or receive phone calls, check voicemail, and use other
voice services. You may enable PCS Vision services again at any time.
TodisablePCSVisionservices:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select PCSVision and press
.
4. Select DisableVision and press . (A message will appear.)
5. Press Disable (right softkey) to confirm that you want to sign out.
ToenablePCSVisionservices:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select PCSVision and press
.
4. Select EnableVision and press
5. Press OK (left softkey) to sign in.
.
Section 2C: Setting Your Phone’s Security
72
Section 2D
Controlling Your Roaming Experience
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ UnderstandingRoaming
SettingYourPhone’sRoamMode
ControllingRoamingChargesUsingCallGuard
Roamingistheabilitytomakeorreceivecallswhenyou’reoffthe
SprintNationwidePCSNetwork. Your new dual-band/tri-mode
PCS Vision Phone works anywhere on the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network and allows you to roam on other analog and 1900 and
800 MHz digital networks where we’ve implemented roaming
agreements with other carriers.
This section explains how roaming works as well as special features
that let you manage your roaming experience.
Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming Experience
73
Understanding Roaming
RecognizingIconsontheDisplayScreen
Your phone’s display screen always lets you know when you’re off
the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and whether your phone is
operating in analog or digital mode. The following chart indicates
what you’ll see depending on where you’re using your phone.
Main LCD/Sub LCD
Roaming Indicator
Analog Indicator
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network
Other Digital Networks
Digital Roam
Analog Networks
Analog Roam
Tip: Remember, when you are using your phone off the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network, always dial numbers using 11 digits (1 + area code + number).
Note: Unless your PCS Service Plan includes roaming, you will pay a higher
per-minute rate for roaming calls.
RoamingonOtherDigitalNetworks
When you’re roaming on digital networks, your call quality and
security will be similar to the quality you receive when making calls
on the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. However, you may not be
able to access certain features, such as PCS Vision.
Note: PCS Ready Link Service is not available in roaming areas.
Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming Experience
74
RoamingonAnalogNetworks
When you roam on analog networks, you will experience a similar
quality provided by other analog carriers today. Although some
features, such as PCS Vision, PCS Ready Link, and PCS Voice Command,
will be unavailable, you can still make and receive calls and access
voicemail. If you are accustomed to PCS Service, you may notice some
of the following differences when using analog service:
ⅷ
You are more likely to experience static, cross-talk, fade-out, and
dropped calls.
ⅷ
Some features which are standard on the enhanced
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, such as call waiting, PCS Vision,
PCS Ready Link, and direct international dialing, may not be
available.
ⅷ
Though callers can leave voicemail messages while you are
roaming, you may not receive notification until you return to the
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. (See “Checking for Voicemail
Messages While Roaming” on the next page).
ⅷ
There are security and privacy risks (eavesdropping and cloning)
that exist with conventional analog services today.
ⅷ
Your battery’s charge will deplete more quickly and you will need
to recharge it more often when you use your phone for analog
roaming.
Note: If you’re on a call when you leave the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and
enter an area where roaming is available (whether digital or analog), your call is
dropped. If your call is dropped in an area where you think PCS Service is
available, turn your phone off and on again to reconnect to the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network.
Note: When using your phone in analog mode, the phone may feel warm. This is
normal for analog operation.
Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming Experience
75
CheckingforVoicemailMessagesWhileRoaming
When you are roaming off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, you
may not receive on-phone notification of new voicemail messages.
Callers can still leave messages, but you will need to periodically
check your voicemail for new messages if you are in a roaming
service area for an extended period of time.
Tocheckyourvoicemailwhileroaming:
ᮣ
Dial 1+area code+your PCS Phone Number.
When you return to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, voicemail
notification will resume as normal.
SettingYour Phone’s Roam Mode
Your PCS Vision Phone allows you to control your roaming
capabilities. By using the Roaming menu option, you can determine
which signals your phone accepts.
SetMode
Choose from three different settings on your dual-band/tri-mode
phone to control your roaming experience.
Tosetyourphone’sroammode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Roaming and press
4. Select SetMode and press
.
.
.
5. Select an option from the following, and press
.
Ⅲ
Sprint allows you to access the enhanced Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network only and prevents roaming on other networks.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Automatic seeks PCS Service. When PCS Service is
unavailable, the phone searches for an alternate system.
Analog forces the phone to seek an analog roaming system.
The previous setting (Sprint or Automatic) is restored the
next time the phone is turned on.
Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming Experience
76
ControllingRoamingChargesUsingCallGuard
Your phone has two ways of alerting you when you are roaming off
the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network: the onscreen roaming icon and
Call Guard. Call Guard makes it easy to manage your roaming charges
by requiring an extra step before you can place or answer a roaming
call. (This additional step is not required when you make or receive
calls while on the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.)
ToturnCallGuardonoroff:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select Roaming and press
4. Select CallGuard and press
5. Select On or Off and press
.
.
.
.
ToplaceroamingcallswithCallGuardon:
1. From standby mode, dial 1 + area code + the seven-digit
number. (You can also initiate a call from the Contacts directory,
Call History, or Messaging.)
2. Press
or
(or press Options (right softkey) and
highlight Call or Call:SpeakerOn) and press
.
3. Press
to proceed while the pop-up message is displayed.
– or –
Press any key to erase the pop-up message, press Options (right
softkey), highlight RoamCall, or Roam:SpeakerOn, and press
.
ToanswerincomingroamingcallswithCallGuardon:
ᮣ
Press Options (right softkey), highlight Answer or
Answer:Speaker, and press
.
– or –
1. Press
or
.
2. Press
to proceed while the pop-up message is displayed.
Reminder: If the Call Guard feature is set to On, you need to take extra steps to
make and receive roaming calls, even if you have selected the Analog setting
(see the previous page).
Section 2D: Controlling Your Roaming Experience
77
Section 2E
Navigating Through Menus
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ MenuNavigation
MenuStructure
ViewingtheMenus
EveryfunctionandfeatureofyourPM-8200bySanyocanbeaccessed
throughanonscreenmenu. This section is a road map to using your
PCS Vision Phone. Please take a few moments to learn your way
around and you’ll find your phone easier to use.
Section 2E: Navigating Through Menus
78
Menu Navigation
The navigation key on your PCS Vision Phone allows you to scroll
through menus quickly and easily. The scroll bar at the right of the
menu keeps track of your position in the menu at all times.
To navigate through a menu, simply press the navigation key up
or down.
Menu Structure
SelectingMenuItems
As you navigate through the menu, menu options are highlighted.
Select any numbered option by simply pressing the corresponding
number on the phone’s keypad. You may also select any item by
highlighting it and pressing
Forexample,ifyouwanttoviewyourlastincomingcall:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select CallHistory by pressing . (It may already be highlighted.)
3. Select Incoming by pressing or by highlighting it and
.
pressing . (If you have received any calls, they are displayed
on the screen.)
BackingUpWithinaMenu
Togotothepreviousmenu:
ᮣ
Press
.
Toreturntostandbymode:
ᮣ
Press
.
Shortcuts
Right navigation key to take a shortcut to the Contacts menu.
Left navigation key to take a shortcut to the MyShortcut menu.
(See page 56 for setting.)
Up navigation key to take a shortcut to the Messaging menu.
Down navigation key to take a shortcut to the Downloads menu.
Section 2E: Navigating Through Menus
79
Viewing the Menus
MenuDiagram
The following list outlines your phone’s menu structure.
1. Call History
1. Outgoing
2. Incoming
3. Missed
4. Erase History
2. Contacts
1. Find/Add Entry
2. Speed Dial #s
3. My Phone#
4. Services
3. Messaging
1. Send Message
2. Picture Mail
3. Text Msg
4. Go to Email
5. Voicemail
4. Web
5. Pictures
1. Camera
2. My Pictures
3. Online Albums
4. Account Info
6. Downloads
1. Games
2. Ringers
3. Screen Savers
4. Applications
5. Dynamic 1-10 (If applicable)
6. Others
Section 2E: Navigating Through Menus
80
7. Settings
1. Sounds
1. Ringer/Key Vol.
2. Ringer Type
3. Alerts
4. Receiver Vol.
5. Others
2. Display
1. Backlight
2. Greeting
3. Font Size
4. Background
5. Animation
6. Incoming Calls
7. Match Area Code
8. Standby Display
9. My Buddy
10.Sleep Mode
3. PCS Vision
1. Enable (or Disable) Vision
2. Net Guard
3. Update Profile
4. Ready Link
1. Enable/Disable
2. List Update
3. Restart R-Link
4. R-Link Guard
5. Ringer Type
6. Alerts
7. Speakerphone
8. Default View
5. Location
6. Roaming
1. Set Mode
2. Call Guard
7. Messaging
1. Display Pop-up
2. Preset Msgs
3. Send Callback#
8. Security
1. Lock Phone
2. Lock Picture
3. Erase Ph. Book
4. Erase Download
5. Reset Pictures
6. Reset Phone
7. Others
Section 2E: Navigating Through Menus
81
9. Others
1. Any Key Answer
2. Auto Answer
3. Open/Close Flip
4. Abbrev. Dial
5. Headset Mode
6. TTY
7. Side Key Guard
8. My Shortcut
9. Airplane Mode
10.Set Time/Date
11.Language
0. Phone Info
1. Phone#/User ID
2. Help
3. Version
4. Advanced
8. Tools/Extras
1. Calendar
2. Alarm Clock
3. Calculator
4. World Clock
5. PC Sync
1. Ringers
2. Images
3. Erase Data
9. Voice Services
1. Voice Memo
1. Record
2. Play
3. Play:Speaker
4. Erase All
2. Screen Call
1. Auto
2. Annoucement
3. Voice Dial
1. Program
2. Review
3. Review:Speaker
4. Erase All
Section 2E: Navigating Through Menus
82
Section 2F
Managing Call History
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ViewingHistory
CallHistoryOptions
MakingaCallFromCallHistory
SavingaPhoneNumberFromCallHistory
PrependingaPhoneNumberFromCallHistory
ErasingCallHistory
TheCallHistorykeepstrackofincomingcalls, callsmadefromyour
PCSVisionPhone, andmissedcalls. This section guides you through
accessing and making the most of your Call History.
Section 2F: Managing Call History
83
Viewing History
You’ll find the Call History feature very helpful. They are lists of the
last 20 voice calls and the last 10 Ready Link calls that you placed,
accepted, or missed. Call History makes redialing a number fast and
easy. It is continually updated as new numbers are added to the
beginning of the list and the oldest entries are removed from the
bottom of the list.
Each entry contains the phone number (if it is available) and
contact’s name (if the phone number is in your Contacts). Duplicate
calls (same number and type of call) may only appear once on the list.
ToviewaCallHistoryentry:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select CallHistory and press
.
3. Select Outgoing, Incoming, or Missed and press . (The selected
Call History list will display.)
Tip: You can switch the Voice Call history to the PCS Ready Link call history by
pressing R-Link (left softkey). To return to the Voice Call history, press Voice Call
(left softkey).
Section 2F: Managing Call History
84
Call History Options
For additional information and options on a particular call, highlight
a Call History entry and press Options (right softkey).
ⅷ
Call to dial the phone number.
ⅷ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone mode.
ⅷ
SendMessage to send a text message. See page 195 for details.
To send Picture Mail, see page 162.
ⅷ
SavePhone# to save the phone number (if applicable). If the
caller’s phone number is already saved in your Contacts list,
GotoPhoneBook appears. (See “Saving a Phone Number From Call
History” on the next page.)
ⅷ
Prepend to add numbers to the beginning of the phone number.
(See “Prepending a Phone Number From Call History” on
page 87.)
ⅷ
CopytoPersonal to copy the phone number to the Ready Link
Personal List. (Only appears when PCS Ready Link mode is set to
Enable and the number does not match any stored entry in your
Personal List.)
ⅷ
Erase to erase the entry.
Making a Call From Call History
ToplaceacallfromCallHistory:
1. Press
2. Select CallHistory and press
3. Select Outgoing, Incoming or Missed and press
4. Highlight the entry you want to call by scrolling through the list.
to access the main menu.
.
.
5. Press
or
.
– or –
Press Options (right softkey), highlight Call or Call:SpeakerOn,
and press
.
Note: You cannot make calls from Call History to entries identified as No ID or
Restricted.
Section 2F: Managing Call History
85
Saving a Phone Number From Call History
Your PCS Vision Phone can store up to 500 phone numbers in up to
300 Contacts entries (an entry may contain up to seven numbers).
Each entry’s name can contain sixteen characters.
TosaveaphonenumberfromCallHistory:
1. Highlight the call history entry you want to save.
2. Press Options (right softkey) to display the options.
3. Highlight SavePhone# and press
4. Highlight the appropriate label (Mobile, Home, Work, Pager,
Fax, Other, or No Label) and press
5. Enter a name and press
.
.
.
If you have already stored entries in the Contacts list, you are
prompted to select the following entry mode:
Ⅲ
NewName to enter a name directly.
Ⅲ
FromPh. Book to select a name from the Contacts list.
6. Press Save (left softkey).
After you have saved the number, the new Contacts entry is
displayed. (See “Contacts List Entry Options” on page 92.)
Note: You cannot save phone numbers already in your Contacts list or from calls
identified as No ID or Restricted. If the selected entry has already been stored in
the Contacts list, Go to Phone Book appears during step 3 above.
Section 2F: Managing Call History
86
PrependingaPhoneNumberFromCallHistory
If you need to place a call from Call History and you happen to be
outside your local area code, you can add the appropriate prefix by
prepending the number.
ToprependaphonenumberfromCallHistory:
1. Highlight a call history entry and press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight Prepend and press
3. Enter the digits you want to add to the number.
4. Press or to place a call.
To select another option, press Options (right softkey), highlight it
.
and press
.
ⅷ
Call to dial the phone number.
ⅷ
ⅷ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone mode.
SavePhone# to store the phone number in your Contacts
directory.
ⅷ
ⅷ
H
T
HardPause to insert a hard pause.
2-Sec. Pause to insert a 2-second pause.
Erasing Call History
To erase individual Call History entries, see “Call History Options” on
page 85.
ToeraseCallHistory:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select CallHistory and press
.
3. Select EraseHistory and press
.
4. Select Outgoing, Incoming, Missed, or All and press
.
5. Select VoiceCalls or ReadyLink and press
.
Ⅲ
VoiceCalls to erase call history for voice calls.
Ⅲ
ReadyLink to erase call history for PCS Ready Link calls.
6. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2F: Managing Call History
87
Section 2G
Using the Contacts Directory
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ DisplayingtheContactsList
AddingaNewContactsEntry
FindingContactsListEntries
ContactsListEntryOptions
AddingaPhoneNumbertoaContactsEntry
EditingaContactsEntry’sPhoneNumber
AssigningSpeedDialNumbers
EditingaContactsEntry
SelectingaRinger/ImageTypeforan Entry
SecretContactsEntries
DialingPCSServices
Nowthatyouknowthebasicsthatmakeiteasiertostayintouchwith
peopleandinformation, you’rereadytoexploreyourphone’smore
advancedfeatures. This section explains how to use your phone’s
Contacts and helps you make the most of your contacts and time
when you are trying to connect with the important people in
your life.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
88
Displaying the Contacts List
ᮣ
Press the navigation key right.
– or –
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
Adding a New Contacts Entry
Your PCS Vision Phone can store up to 500 phone numbers in up to
300 Contacts entries (an entry may contain up to seven numbers).
Each entry’s name can contain sixteen characters.
Toaddanewentry:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
.
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
.
Ⅲ
Press the navigation key right for the shortcut (steps 1
through 3).
4. Highlight <AddContact> and press
5. Enter a name and press
6. Select a label by using your navigation key and press
.
.
.
7. Enter the phone number or address and press
8. Press Save (left softkey).
– or –
.
1. Press the navigation key right to display the Contacts list.
2. Highlight an entry and press Options (right softkey).
3. Highlight AddNewContact and press
.
4. Follow steps 5-8 above.
After you have saved the number, the new Contacts entry is
displayed. (See “Contacts List Entry Options” on page 92.)
Tip: You can also add a new Contacts entry by entering a number from standby
mode. See “Saving a Phone Number” on page 27.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
89
Finding Contacts List Entries
There are several ways to display your Contacts entries: by name, by
speed dial number, by group, and by voice dial tags. Follow the steps
outlined in the sections below to display entries from the Contacts
list menu.
FindingNames
TofindContactslistentriesbyname:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
.
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
.
Ⅲ
Press the navigation key right for the shortcut (steps 1
through 3).
4. Use your navigation key to scroll through the Contacts list.
– or –
Enter the first letter of the name or part of the name. (The
display shows the entries beginning with the letter entered.)
5. Press
to display the entry’s details.
TofindPCSReadyLinkListentries:
1. From standby mode, press the navigation key right to display
your Contacts list.
2. Press Goto (left softkey). Highlight your desired list and press
.
Ⅲ
PhoneBook to display the Contacts list.
Ⅲ
CompanyList to display the Company List.
Ⅲ
CompanyGroups to display the Company Group List.
Ⅲ
PersonalList to display the Personal List.
Ⅲ
PersonalGroups to display the Personal Group List.
3. Scroll through the list to select your desired entry.
Note: The Go to (left softkey) option does not appear when PCS Ready Link mode
is set to Disable (see “Setting PCS Ready Link Mode” on page 133).
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
90
FindingSpeedDialNumbers
Tofindphonenumbersyouhavestoredinspeeddiallocations:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
.
3. Select SpeedDial#s and press . (The Speed Dial numbers list
appears.)
FindingVoiceDialNumbers
TofindphonenumbersyouhavestoredinVoiceDial:
1. Press
2. Select VoiceServices and press
3. Select VoiceDial and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
4. Select Review or Review:Speaker and press . (The Voice Dial
numbers list appears.)
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
91
Contacts List Entry Options
To access a contact’s options, display the Contacts list, highlight an
entry and press . Then select a phone number and press Options
(right softkey). To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
Edit to edit the selected entry.
ⅷ
Call to dial the selected number.
ⅷ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone mode.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
SendMessage to send a text message. (See page 195 for details.)
To send Picture Mail, see page 162.
CallAlarm to set a call alarm for the entry. (See page 104 for Call
Alarm.)
SetSpeedDial to assign speed dial numbers to your favorite
entries. (See “Assigning Speed Dial Numbers” on page 94.)
SetVoiceDial to set a voice dial for the entry. (See page 124 for
Voice Dial.)
Prepend to alter a phone number by adding numbers to the
beginning of the entry. (See “Prepending a Phone Number From
Call History” on page 87.)
ⅷ
CopytoPersonal to copy the phone number to your Ready Link
Personal List. (Only appears when PCS Ready Link mode is set to
Enable and the number does not match any stored entry in your
Personal List.)
ToerasetheselectedentryfromtheContactslist:
1. From standby mode, press the navigation key right to display
the Contacts list.
2. Highlight the entry you wish to delete by using the navigation
key.
3. Press Options (right softkey).
4. Highlight EraseContact and press
5. Select Yes and press
.
.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
92
Adding a Phone Number to a Contacts Entry
Toaddaphonenumbertoanentry:
1. Display a Contacts entry (see “Finding Contacts List Entries” on
page 90).
2. Highlight a phone number, press Options (right softkey),
highlight Edit, and press
.
3. Highlight the label field you want to add and press
.
4. Enter the number and press
.
5. Press Save (left softkey).
Editing a Contacts Entry’s Phone Number
Toeditanentry’sphonenumber:
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Highlight the entry you wish to edit and press
3. Highlight a phone number, press Options (right softkey),
highlight Edit, and press
.
.
4. Select the number you want to edit and press
5. Edit the entry by using your keypad and press
6. Press Save (left softkey) to save your changes.
.
.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
93
Assigning Speed Dial Numbers
With this feature you can dial Contacts Directory entries with one
key press for locations 2-9. Save your memory locations 2-9 for speed
dialing your most commonly used phone numbers. Speed Dial
numbers must be stored in your Contacts to use this feature.
TosetSpeedDial:
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select SpeedDial#s and press
4. To select a corresponding speed dial number from 2-9,
highlight an unassigned number and press
5. Select an entry from the list and press
6. Select the phone number you want to set as a speed dial and
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
.
press
.
– or –
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Highlight your desired entry by scrolling through the Contacts
list and press
.
3. Highlight the phone number you want to set as a speed dial and
press Options (right softkey).
4. Highlight SetSpeedDial and press
.
5. Highlight an unassigned number and press
.
Ⅲ
When you highlight an assigned number and press
,
you’ll be asked whether you want to overwrite the assigned
number. Select Yes to overwrite or No to cancel.
Tocancelastoredspeeddialnumber:
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select SpeedDial#s and press
4. Highlight the stored speed dial number you want to cancel and
press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Highlight Unassign and press
.
TouseSpeedDial:
ᮣ
From standby mode, just press and hold the appropriate key.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
94
Editing a Contacts Entry
Tomakechangestoanentry:
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Highlight the entry you wish to edit and press
.
3. Highlight a phone number, press Options (right softkey),
highlight Edit, and press
.
– or –
Highlight an email address or Web address and press Edit (right
softkey).
4. Select the field you want to edit and press
.
5. Edit the entry by using your keypad and press
.
6. Press Save (left softkey) to save your changes.
Selecting a Ringer/ImageType for an Entry
You can assign a ringer or an image type to a Contacts entry so you can
identify the caller by the ringer or image type. (See “Ringer Types” on
page 36.)
Toselectaringertypeforanentry:
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Select the entry for which you want to set the incoming ringer
and press
.
3. Highlight a phone number, press Options (right softkey),
highlight Edit, and press
.
– or –
Highlight an email address or Web address and press Edit (right
softkey).
4. Scroll to Ringer and press
.
5. Use your navigation key to scroll through available ringers.
(When you highlight a ringer type, a sample ringer will sound.)
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
95
6. Highlight your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
RingerType to select a ringer type. Scroll through available
ringers to hear previews.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ringer&Voice to notify you with Ringer and Voice.
Vibrate to notify you by vibrating.
Normal to set Ringer to the incoming calls setting
(see page 36).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
None to turn the ringer type off.
Downloads to set a downloaded image saved in your phone.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download.
7. Press Save (left softkey) to save the ringer type.
Ⅲ
To confirm the ringer, highlight Ringer and press Play (right
softkey).
Toselectanimagetypeforanentry:
1. Follow steps 1-3 on the previous page.
2. Scroll to PictureID and press
.
3. Select a menu by scrolling up or down and press
.
4. Highlight your desired image type and press
.
Ⅲ
Normal to set Image to the incoming calls setting
(see page 47).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
None to turn the image type off.
Downloads to set a downloaded image saved in your phone.
GetNew to start up the browser so you can select an item to
download.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
InCamera to set a picture saved in your In Camera folder.
SavedtoPh. to set a picture saved in your Saved to Phone
folder.
5. Press Save (left softkey) to save the image type.
Ⅲ
To see a display preview of an image, press Preview (right
softkey) during step 5 above. Press the right softkey to
switch between Main/Sub LCD’s display preview.
Note: If you set an animation ringer (indicated with
icon) and an image, your
PCS Phone plays the ringer (audio) of the animation ringer and displays the
image you selected.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
96
Secret Contacts Entries
You can hide an entry’s phone number(s) and require your lock code
to edit the entry by making it secret. The entry name is still displayed,
but the entry’s phone numbers are replaced with “(Secret)”.
Tomakeanentrysecret:
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Scroll to the Contacts entry you want to tag secret.
3. Press Options (right softkey) to display the menu options.
4. Highlight SetSecret and press
.
5. Enter the 4-digit lock code.
6. Select On and press
.
Tomakeanentrypublic:
1. Press the navigation key right.
2. Scroll to the Contacts entry you want to tag public.
3. Press Options (right softkey) to display the menu options.
4. Highlight SetSecret and press
.
5. Enter the 4-digit lock code.
6. Select Off and press
.
Tip: If you can’t recall your lock code, try using the last four digits of either your
Social Security number or your PCS Phone Number or try 0000.
If none of these work, call PCS Customer Solutions at 1-888-211-4PCS (4727).
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
97
Dialing PCS Services
Your Contacts list is preprogrammed with contact numbers for various
PCS Services. You must be in digital mode to access PCS Services.
Todialaservice:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
.
.
3. Select Services and press
4. Select CustSolutions, DirAssistance, AccountInfo, SprintOperator,
or VoiceCommand and press
.
5. Press
or
.
– or –
Press Options (right softkey), highlight Call or Call:SpeakerOn,
and press
.
Section 2G: Using the Contacts Directory
98
Section 2H
Personal Organizer
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ManagingtheScheduler
UsingYourPhone’sScheduler
AddingaCallAlarmtotheScheduler
AddingToDoListItems
PurgingAllEvents, CallAlarms, orToDoListItems
PersonalInformationManagement
UsingYourPhone’sTools
DownloadingFilesThroughPCSVision
YourPCSVisionPhoneisequippedwithseveralpersonalinformation
managementfeaturesthathelpyoumanageyourbusylifestyle.
This section shows you how to use these features to turn your
phone into a time management planner that helps you keep up
with your contacts, schedules, and commitments. It takes
productivity to a whole new level.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
99
Managing the Scheduler
Calendar
Use the Calendar to remind you of events or important calls you need
to make. You can schedule up to 100 events, 15 Call Alarms, and
20 To-Do List items.
SettingtheTime/Date
In a no-service area or an analog service area, it’s necessary to set the
actual time and date to use the Calendar function. Set the current
Time/Date by using numeric keys and/or the navigation key
(Right/Left: move cursor, Up/Down: change value). To display the
time setting mode, press , select Tools/Extras and press
Then select Calendar and press
.
.
You can set any time from 12:00 AM, Jan 1, 2000 to 11:59 PM,
Dec 31, 2099.
SettingHolidays
You can set your personal holidays by displaying the date in red on
the Calendar display. The default holidays displayed in red are
Sundays and national holidays.
Note: You can set holidays from Jan 1, 2000 to Dec 31, 2020.
Tosetpersonalholidays:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
3. Select Calendar and press
.
4. Highlight the day you want to set to the holiday by using the
navigation key (Left: previous day, Right: next day, Up: previous
week, Down: next week,
: previous/next month).
5. Press Options (right softkey), highlight Holiday, and press
.
6. Highlight SetDate or SetWeekly from the options and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
100
Options:
ⅷ
SetDate sets the selected date for the holiday.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
SetWeekly sets weekly holidays.
ResetDate resets the holiday setting for the selected date.
ResetWeekly resets the weekly holiday setting.
ResetAll resets all the holiday settings and returns to the default
settings.
7. If you selected SetWeekly, ResetWeekly, or ResetAll, you’ll be
prompted to select Yes or No.
Tip: The current day is framed by a rectangle.
UsingYour Phone’s Scheduler
Adding an Event to the Scheduler
Your Scheduler helps organize your time and reminds you of
important events (up to 100 events).
Toaddanevent:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
3. Select Calendar and press
.
4. Select the day you want to add an event to by using the
navigation key and press
.
5. Press Options (right softkey) to display the options.
6. Select AddEvent and press
.
7. Select Schedule and press
.
8. Enter the description using your keypad, and press
press Mode [right softkey] to select a description from
“From To Do List”).
(or
Note: The “From To Do List ”option will not appear if there are no items stored in
the To Do List. See “Adding To Do List Items” on page 107 for details.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
101
9. Select the menu under the following options and press
.
Ⅲ
Description to enter a description of your event (up to 14
characters).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
From to schedule the start time.
To to schedule the end time.
Location to edit the location of your event (up to 14
characters).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Alarm to select your desired ringer.
AlarmTime to edit the alarm time (number of hours or
minutes before the event starts). Default alarm time is 10
minutes before.
Ⅲ
Repeat to set the event’s repeating status. Select None, Daily,
Weekly, Monthly, or Yearly.
10. Press Save (left softkey) to schedule the event.
Tip: The date you have scheduled events for is indicated by “ ”.
Tip: Press the navigation key up or down to scroll by week through the Scheduler
calendar and the Side Volume key to scroll by month.
Event Alerts
There are several ways your PCS Vision Phone alerts you of scheduled
events:
ⅷ
By playing the alert tone (depending on the Ringer Type and
Ringer Volume setting).
ⅷ
By blinking the LED.
ⅷ
By displaying the event’s description on the Main LCD when the
flip is open.
ⅷ
By displaying the event’s description on the Sub LCD when the
flip is closed.
ⅷ
By lighting the LCD backlight (depending on the backlight setting).
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
102
EventAlert Menu
When your phone is turned on and you have an event alarm
scheduled, your phone alerts you and displays the event summary.
Torespondtoaneventalert:
1. Press
or View (left softkey) to silence the alarm and see the
event details.
2. Highlight the unchecked event and press
to see the event
details or press Options (right softkey) for the following options.
To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
Snooze to repeat the alarm in ten minutes.
Ⅲ
Exit to exit the options.
Note: If you press Exit (left softkey) during step 2 above, you are prompted to
erase the unchecked event. Select Yes to erase or No to cancel.
Viewing Events
Toviewyourscheduledevents:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
3. Select Calendar and press
.
4. Select the date for which you set events and press . (The
selected day’s events list will display.)
Erasing a Day’s Events or CallAlarms
Toeraseascheduledday’seventsorcallalarms:
1. From the Event list display (see above), highlight one of the
events or call alarms and press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight EraseEvent and press
.
3. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
103
Adding a CallAlarm to the Scheduler
You can set call alarms to notify you when you need to place a call.
The call alarm will let you know when and to whom to place a
scheduled call. You can set up to 15 call alarms.
ToaddacallalarmtotheScheduler:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
3. Select Calendar and press
.
4. Select the day you want to add a call alarm to by using the
navigation key and press
.
5. From the event list display, press Options (right softkey) to
display the options.
6. Select AddEvent and press
.
7. Select CallAlarm and press
.
8. Enter the phone number directly or press Options (right softkey)
for options.
Ⅲ
FromPhoneBook to select the desired number from your
Contacts list.
Ⅲ
Voicemail to select the number for voicemail access.
9. Select the box under the following items and press
.
Ⅲ
Time/Date to edit the start time/date.
Ⅲ
Alarm to select the ringer alarm.
Ⅲ
Repeat to set the Call Alarm’s repeat status. Select None,
Daily, Weekly, Monthly, or Yearly.
10. Press Save (left softkey).
Tip: You can also add a call alarm from the Contacts menu (see “Contacts List
Entry Options” on page 92).
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
104
CallAlarm Alerts
There are several ways your PCS Phone alerts you of a scheduled call
alarm:
ⅷ
By playing the alert tone (depending on the Ringer Type and
Ringer Volume setting).
ⅷ
By blinking the LED.
ⅷ
By displaying the call alarm notification on the Main LCD when
the flip is open.
ⅷ
By displaying the call alarm notification on the Sub LCD when the
flip is closed.
ⅷ
By lighting the LCD backlight (depending on the backlight setting).
CallAlarm Menu
When your phone is turned on and you have scheduled a call alarm,
your phone alerts you and displays the name or phone number you
wish to call.
Torespondtoacallalarm:
1. Press
or View (left softkey) to silence the alarm and see the
call alarm details.
2. Highlight the unchecked event and press
to see the call
alarm details, or press Options (right softkey) for the following
options (to select an option, highlight it and press ):
Ⅲ
Call to dial the scheduled phone number.
Ⅲ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the scheduled phone number in
speakerphone mode.
Ⅲ
Snooze to repeat the alarm in ten minutes.
Ⅲ
SavePhone# to save the scheduled phone number in your
Contacts list. GotoPhoneBook appears when the number is
already in your Contacts list. (See “Saving a Phone Number”
on page 27.)
Note: If you press Exit (left softkey) during step 2 above, you are prompted to
erase the unchecked event. Select Yes to erase or No to cancel.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
105
Editing a CallAlarm
Toeditacallalarm:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), highlight one of the
call alarms and press . (The call alarm details appear.)
2. Select the box you want to edit and press
3. Enter or select a new setting and press
4. Press Save (left softkey).
.
.
Viewing a Future/Past Day’s Scheduled Events
Toviewafuture/pastday’sscheduledevents:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight GoToDate and press
.
3. Enter the date by using numeric keys and the navigation key
and press
4. Press
or OK (left softkey).
once again to view the day’s Event list.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
106
Adding To Do List Items
Your phone can store and manage up to 20 To Do List items.
ToaddanitemtoyourToDoList:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight ToDoList and press
3. Press Options (right softkey).
4. Highlight AddItem and press
.
.
5. Enter the description (up to 14 characters) and press
.
6. Select the menu under Priority and press to edit the To Do’s
priority. You can select from Normal, !Urgent, or √Done.
7. Press Save (left softkey).
Viewing theTo Do List
ToviewyourToDoList:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight ToDoList and press
.
Ⅲ
To see the details of each To Do List item, select an item and
press
.
EditingTo Do List Items
ToeditaToDoListitem:
1. From the To Do List display, highlight the item you want to edit
and press
.
2. Highlight the box you want to edit and press
.
3. Edit the description or change the priority and press
.
4. Press Save (left softkey).
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
107
Adding aTo Do List Item to the Schedule
ToaddyourToDoListitemtotheschedule:
1. From the To Do List display, highlight the item you want to add
to the schedule and press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight AddToSchedule and press
.
Ⅲ
AddToSchedule to extract the item from the To Do List and
make it a scheduled event.
3. Enter the description using your keypad and press . (See
“Adding an Event to the Scheduler” on page 101 for entering.)
4. Press Save (left softkey).
Deleting Items From theTo Do List
TodeleteToDoListitems:
1. From the To Do List display (see the previous page), highlight
the item you want to erase and press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight your desired option and press
.
Ⅲ
EraseItem erases an item from the To Do List.
Ⅲ
EraseSelection erases multiple selected To Do List items at
one time. Press
to check the box(es) next to the To Do
List item(s) you want to delete and press Erase (left softkey)
to erase. To check all boxes, press Options (right softkey),
highlight CheckAll, and press
.
Ⅲ
EraseAll erases all To Do List items.
3. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
108
Viewing Memory inYour Scheduler
Toviewavailablememoryspaceandoptions:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight ViewMemory and press
.
3. Highlight Schedule, CallAlarm, or ToDoList and press . (The
available memory space and options display.)
For further options:
4. Press Options (right softkey).
5. Highlight an option and press
.
Ⅲ
EraseOld deletes old events or call alarms.
Ⅲ
EraseSelection deletes the To Do List items you selected.
(See “Deleting Items From the To Do List ” on the
previous page.)
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
EraseDone deletes the To Do List items that have been
completed.
EraseAll deletes all events, call alarms, or To Do List items.
6. Select Yes or No and press
.
PurgingAll Events,CallAlarms,or
To Do List Items
Todeleteallscheduledevents,callalarms,orToDoListitems:
1. From the Event list display (see page 103), press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight EraseMemory and press
.
3. Highlight one item from the options and press
.
Ⅲ
EraseOld deletes old events, call alarms, and To Do List items
that are done.
Ⅲ
EraseAll deletes all events, call alarms, and To Do List items.
4. Select Yes or No and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
109
Personal Information Management
DisplayingYour UserAddress
Todisplaythephone’scurrentuseraddress:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select PhoneInfo and press
.
4. Select Phone#/UserID and press
.
Ⅲ
If you sign out, <PCS Vision Disabled> appears on the display.
Finding Icon Definitions
Toviewanexplanationoficonsthatappearonthedisplay:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select PhoneInfo and press
.
4. Select Help and press
.
5. Select the item for which you want to see the explanation and
press . (The icon’s explanation appears.)
6. Press Done (left softkey) or
to end.
Tip: Press the navigation key up or down to scroll the message manually.
Displaying the Version Information
Todisplaytheversionnumberofthesoftware,hardware,PRL
(PreferredRoamingList),PRI(ProductReleaseInstructions),etc.,
installedonyourPCSPhone:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select PhoneInfo and press
4. Select Version and press
.
.
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
110
Displaying Advanced Information
Todisplayadvancedinformationsuchastechnologyandfrequency:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select PhoneInfo and press
4. Select Advanced and press
.
.
.
UsingYour Phone’sTools
In addition to helping you be more efficient and organized, your
PCS Vision Phone offers useful and entertaining tools.
Using the Alarm Clock
Your phone comes with a built-in alarm clock with alarm capabilities.
Tousethealarmclock:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
.
3. Select AlarmClock and press
4. A caution message will appear on the display. Press Continue
(left softkey) to continue.
5. Select the box under the following items and press
.
Ⅲ
Alarm to set the alarm On/Off. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
Time to enter the alarm time. Enter the desired alarm time
and press
.
Ⅲ
Repeat to select the alarm frequency. Select None to set your
alarm once or Daily to set your alarm daily.
6. Press Done (left softkey) to save the alarm settings.
Note: Alarm will not sound when the phone is powered off.
Tostopthealarm:
ᮣ
Press any key to stop the alarm.
Ⅲ
Press Exit (right softkey) to exit the alarm clock display.
Tip: The alarm stops in 30 seconds automatically.
Note: You can adjust the ringer type and ringer volume in your Settings menu.
To change the ringer type, see “Selecting Ringer Types for Calendar” on page 39.
To change the ringer volume, see “Adjusting the Phone’s Volume Settings” on
page 41.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
111
Using the Calculator
Your phone comes with a built-in calculator.
Tousethecalculator:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
3. Select Calculator and press
.
4. Enter numbers using your keypad. Press the left softkey to
insert a decimal point.
5. Press the appropriate navigation key for an arithmetic option
(Up for addition, Down for subtraction, Left for multiplication,
Right for division).
6. Enter numbers and press
for the result.
Ⅲ
To clear the numbers, press CLR (right softkey).
Ⅲ
To exit the Calculator, press
.
Using the World Clock
This feature is available only in digital service areas.
Tosettheworldclockdisplay:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Tools/Extras and press
.
.
3. Select WorldClock and press
4. The world clock display appears.
Ⅲ
Press the navigation key right or left to change countries.
Press Summer (left softkey) or Standard (right softkey) to select
between daylight savings and standard time (if applicable). “ ” is
shown in summer mode.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
112
Downloading FilesThrough PCSVision
Your PCS Phone allows you to download images (screen savers),
ringers, games, etc., from a PCS Vision connection. It is also possible
to download from certain menus (Contacts list, Ringer Setting, or
Display Setting).
TodownloadafilefromtheWeb:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select your desired data folder (for example, Games, Ringers,
Screen Saver, or Applications) and press
4. Select GetNew and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Select your desired file and follow the system prompts.
6. Press the left softkey to start downloading.
7. Wait for the download to complete.
8. Press
operation.
to end or press the right or left softkey for further
Ⅲ
Rightsoftkey returns to the Download page and you can
continue to download.
Ⅲ
Leftsoftkey assigns the downloaded data. (See “Confirming
the Downloaded Data” on page 117.)
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
113
TodownloadafilefromaContactslistentry:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
4. Select the entry for which you want to set the downloaded
ringer or image and press
5. Highlight a phone number and press Options (right softkey).
.
.
.
Then highlight Edit and press
.
– or –
Highlight an email address or Web address, then press Edit (right
softkey).
6. Scroll to Ringer or PictureID and press
.
7. Highlight GetNew and press . (The browser launches and
displays the Download page.)
8. Select your desired image or ringer file and follow the system
prompts.
9. Press the left softkey to start downloading.
10. Wait for the download to complete.
11. Press
operation.
to end or press the right or left softkey for further
Ⅲ
Rightsoftkey returns to the Download page and you can
continue to download.
Ⅲ
Leftsoftkey assigns the downloaded data. (See “To confirm
the downloaded ringers folder” on page 117 or “To confirm
the downloaded images [screen savers] folder” on
page 118.)
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
114
TodownloadaringerfilefromtheRingerSettingMenu(RingerType
andStart-up/Power-offTone):
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Sounds and press
.
4. Select RingerType and press
.
5. Select one item from VoiceCalls, Voicemail, Messaging, or
Calendar, and press . The following item requires an extra step:
Ⅲ
For VoiceCalls, select the menu under WithCallerID or
NoCallerID.
6. Select the menu under each item and press
.
7. Select GetNew and press . (The browser launches and
displays the Download page.)
8. Select your desired ringer file and follow the system prompts.
9. Press the left softkey to start downloading.
10. Wait for the download to complete.
11. Press
operation.
to end or press the right or left softkey for further
Ⅲ
Rightsoftkey returns to the Download page and you can
continue to download.
Ⅲ
Leftsoftkey assigns the downloaded data. (See “To confirm
the downloaded ringers folder” on page 117.)
TodownloadaringerfilefromtheStart-up/Power-offTonemenu:
1. Select Others during step 4 above and press
2. Select the menu under Start-upTone or Power-offTone and
press
.
.
3. Follow the previous steps 7 to 11.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
115
TodownloadanimagefilefromtheDisplaySettingMenu
(Animation,IncomingCalls,andScreenSaver):
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select Display and press
.
4. Select Animation or IncomingCalls and press
.
The following item requires an extra step:
Ⅲ
For Animation, select the menu under Standby, OutgoingCalls,
or ServiceSearch.
5. Select the menu under each item and press
.
6. Select GetNew and press . (The browser launches and
displays the Download page.)
7. Select your desired image file and follow the system prompts.
8. Press the left softkey to start downloading.
9. Wait for the download to complete.
10. Press
operation.
to end or press the right or left softkey for further
Ⅲ
Rightsoftkey returns to the Download page and you can
continue to download.
Ⅲ
Leftsoftkey assigns the downloaded data. (See “To confirm
the downloaded images [screen savers] folder” on page 118.)
TodownloadanimagefilefromtheScreenSavermenu:
1. Select StandbyDisplay during step 4 above and press
.
2. Select ScreenSaver and press
.
3. Select the menu under ScreenSaver and press
.
4. Follow the previous steps 6 to 10.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
116
Confirming the Downloaded Data
The downloaded data will be classified as games, ringers, images
(screen savers), or applications automatically. However, if any data
has a different category, it is classified as Dynamic. If data doesn’t
belong to any of the above, it is classified as Others.
Toconfirmthedownloadedgamesfolder:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select Games and press
4. Select the downloaded game you want to confirm and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Select Run from the options and press
.
Options:
ⅷ
Run to play the downloaded game.
ⅷ
Settings to set the Network Access availability.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded game.
Properties shows the downloaded game properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded game online information (if
applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Logo/Trademark displays logo and description.
Erase erases the selected downloaded game.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
Toconfirmthedownloadedringersfolder:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select Ringers and press
4. Select the downloaded ringer you want to confirm and press
.
.
.
5. Select Play from the options and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
117
Options:
ⅷ
Play to play the downloaded ringer.
ⅷ
Assign to assign the downloaded ringer to the Voice Calls,
Voicemail, Messaging, Calendar, Start-up/Power-off Tone, or
Phone Book.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded ringer.
Properties shows the downloaded ringer properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded ringer online information (if
applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Erase erases the selected downloaded ringer.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
Toconfirmthedownloadedimages(screensavers)folder:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Select ScreenSavers and press
.
4. Select the downloaded image you want to confirm and press
.
5. Select View from the options and press
.
Options:
ⅷ
View to display the downloaded image.
ⅷ
Assign to assign the downloaded image to the Incoming Calls,
Screen Saver, or Phone Book.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded image.
Properties shows the downloaded image properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded image online information (if
applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Erase erases the selected downloaded image.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
Note: Depending on the data, you can select where to assign your downloaded
files: Image data can be assigned to Incoming Calls, Screen Saver, or Phone Book.
Animation data can be assigned to Standby, Outgoing Calls, or Service Search.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
118
Toconfirmthedownloadedapplicationsfolder:
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Select Applications and press
.
4. Select the downloaded application you want to confirm and
press
.
5. Select Run from the options and press
.
Options:
ⅷ
Run to play the downloaded application.
ⅷ
Settings to set the Network Access availability.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded application.
Properties shows the downloaded application properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded application online
information (if applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Logo/Trademark displays logo and description.
Erase erases the selected downloaded application.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
ToconfirmthedownloadedDynamicfolder:
The downloaded data in the Dynamic folder are varied (options
subject to change).
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select Dynamic-(1to10) and press
4. Select the downloaded data you want to confirm and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Select Open from the options and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
119
Options:
ⅷ
Open to play the downloaded content.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded data.
Properties shows the downloaded data properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded data online information (if
applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Logo/Trademark displays logo and description (if applicable).
Erase erases the selected downloaded data.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
ToconfirmthedownloadedOthersfolder:
The downloaded data in the Others folder are varied (options subject
to change).
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select Others and press
4. Select the downloaded data you want to confirm and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Select Open from the options and press
.
Options:
ⅷ
Open to play the downloaded content.
ⅷ
Options to select the options of the downloaded data.
Properties shows the downloaded data properties.
OnlineInfo shows the downloaded data online information (if
applicable).
Shop allows you to continue downloading (if applicable).
Logo/Trademark displays logo and description (if applicable).
Erase erases the selected downloaded data.
ⅷ
Exit to return to the downloaded data list display.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
120
IconIndication
Type Item
Icon (appears at the left side
of the downloaded data)
From Web Ringers (~128KB)
Voice (~128KB)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(New Data)
(Assigned Data)
(Assigned Data)
(Assigned Data)
(Assigned Data)
(Assigned Data)
Screen Savers/Images (~128KB)
Animation (~128KB)
Animation Ringer (~128KB)
Game (~128KB)
Application (~128KB)
Unknown type (~128KB)
Note: Download icon subject to change
SortingtheDownloadedData
Files downloaded via the Web are stored in alphabetical order. You
may also store the data in memory size order.
Tosortdownloadedfiles:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Select one of each folder that includes the downloaded data you
want to sort.
4. Press
.
5. Press Options (right softkey).
6. Highlight Sorting from the options and press
.
Ⅲ
Sorting to sort the downloaded data in alphabetical (Name)
or memory size (Size) order.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Icon/Size to show the downloaded data list with memory size.
EraseAll to erase all downloaded files you selected during
step 3. (Downloaded data that has already been assigned
cannot be erased.)
7. Highlight Name or Size and press
.
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
121
Viewing the Downloaded Data Size
This feature allows you to confirm each downloaded file’s size and
the remaining download capacity.
Toviewthedatasize:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select one of each folder that includes the downloaded data you
to access the main menu.
.
want to confirm and press
.
4. Press Options (right softkey).
5. Highlight Icon/Size and press . (Data size is displayed at the
left of the downloaded data name.)
ViewingtheMemorySpaceAvailableforDownloads
This feature allows you to confirm how much memory is left and may
be used for downloading files.
Toviewtheavailablememoryspace:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Press Options (right softkey).
4. Highlight ViewMemory and press . (Used and Free memory
size are displayed.)
ErasingOldDownloadedData
If you try to download new data when the downloaded data’s
memory is full, a warning message appears and you will be prompted
to erase some old downloaded data.
Toerasedownloadeddata:
1. When the warning message appears, press Erase (left softkey)
to make a space for new download data. (Press the right softkey
to cancel the download.)
2. Select one of each folder that includes the data you want to
erase and press
.
3. Select the data you want to erase and press Erase (left softkey).
4. Select Yes and press . (You can now continue to download
the new file.)
Section 2H: Personal Organizer
122
Section 2I
Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ UsingVoice-ActivatedDialing
ManagingVoiceMemos
SettingUpScreenCall
YourPCSVisionPhone’sVoiceServicesletyouplacecallsusingyour
voice, storevoicereminders, andrecordmemosrightonyourphone.
This section includes easy-to-follow instructions on using voice-
activated dialing and managing voice memos.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
123
Using Voice-Activated Dialing
SM
In addition to PCS Voice Command (see page 223), you can use a
voice dial tag to automatically dial a phone number in your Contacts.
(A voice dial tag is a command you record and use to place calls
without using the keypad.) Your phone can store up to 30 voice dial
tags. (To create a voice dial tag, see “Adding a New Contacts Entry” on
page 89 or “Editing a Contacts Entry’s Phone Number” on page 93.)
Making a Call UsingVoice-Activated Dialing
Touseavoicedialtagtocallaphonenumber:
With the flip open:
1. Press
or
briefly.
2. Follow the voice prompts and recite the entry’s Voice Dial tag
into your phone’s microphone.
With the flip closed:
1. Press and hold
.
2. Follow the voice prompts and recite the entry’s Voice Dial tag
into your phone’s microphone.
Note: To use the Voice Dial function, you must have a stored entries for Voice Dial
(see “Programming Voice Dial Tags” below).
Programming Voice DialTags
Toprogramavoicedialtag:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceDial and press
.
4. Select Program and press
.
5. The phone will prompt you to say the name you want to
program. Wait for the beep and then say the name.
6. Respond to the prompt by repeating the name after the beep.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
124
7. Enter or highlight the Voice Dial entry (name) in the Contacts
list and press
.
8. Select the labeled category that includes your desired phone
number and press . (The display shows “Voice Dial
Recorded.”)
Note: Record Voice Dial tags in a quiet environment and without the aid of an
accessory (for example, a headset or hands-free car kit).
ReviewingVoice DialTags
Toreviewvoicedialtags:
1. Press
2. Select VoiceServices and press
3. Select VoiceDial and press
4. Select Review or Review:Speaker and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
5. Select the desired entry and press
.
– or –
Select the desired entry and press Options (right softkey). To
select an option, highlight it and press
.
Options:
ⅷ
Play to play the recorded voice dial tag.
ⅷ
SpeakerOn to play the recorded voice dial tag in speakerphone
mode. (If you are in speakerphone mode, the option will appear
as SpeakerOff to deactivate.)
ⅷ
Erase to erase the voice dial tag. Select Yes to erase and No to cancel.
ErasingAllVoice DialTags
Toeraseallvoicedialtags:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceDial and press
.
4. Select EraseAll and press
.
5. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
125
Managing Voice Memos
You can use your phone’s Voice Services to record brief memos to
remind you of important events, phone numbers, or grocery list items.
Tip: If you haven’t signed up for the PCS Ready Link service and PCS Ready Link
mode is set to Disable, you can use the Ready Link (Memo) Button (
) as a
Voice Memo button in standby mode. You can use it to record memos or display
Memo options.
RecordingVoice Memos
Torecordavoicememo:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceMemo and press
.
4. Select Record and press
.
5. Start recording after the beep.
Toendtherecordingofyourmemo:
ᮣ
Press
,
, or
.
Tip: Recording terminates automatically after 18 seconds.
Tip: To record in speakerphone mode, press and hold
in standby mode.
Torecordaconversationduringaphonecall:
1. During a call, press
to see the options.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceMemo and press
.
4. Select Record and press
.
5. Start recording after the beep.
Toendtherecordingofyourconversation:
ᮣ
Press
– or –
Press
or
while recording.
to stop recording and disconnect the call.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
126
Recording also stops when the other party hangs up the call.
ⅷ
Memo recording is disabled while you are roaming in analog
service areas.
ⅷ
When the recording capacity is full, highlight an old memo, and
press Erase (left softkey). Then select Yes and press
to make
room for additional memos.
Note: Your phone can store up to 12 memos and the total available recording time
is 72 seconds (maximum of 18 seconds per memo).
Tip: Voice Memos are stored with the date and time stamp in reverse
chronological order, except when recorded in a no service area.
Voice Memo Options
Toplaythevoicememosyouhaverecorded:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceMemo and press
.
4. Select Play or Play:Speaker and press
.
5. Select one memo from the list and press
.
– or –
If you want to play all memos continuously, highlight All and
press
.
6. Press
to stop playing.
Ⅲ
Press Slow (left softkey) or Fast (right softkey) to change the
playing speed.
Ⅲ
To play the newer/older memo, press the navigation key
right or left.
Tip: To set the speakerphone mode on or off, press Options (right softkey),
highlight Speaker On/Off, and press during step 5 above.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
127
ErasingVoice Memos
Toeraseallvoicememos:
1. Follow steps 1-4 on the previous page.
2. Press Options (right softkey).
3. Select EraseAll and press
.
4. Select Yes and press
.
– or –
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceMemo and press
.
4. Select EraseAll and press
.
5. Select Yes and press
.
Toeraseindividualmemos:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select VoiceMemo and press
.
4. Select Play or Play:Speaker and press
.
5. Display the memo list, highlight the memo you want to erase,
and press Options (right softkey).
6. Select Erase and press
.
7. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
128
Setting Up Screen Call
This feature enables you to screen incoming calls by using a recorded
announcement, either one that is pre-recorded or one that you record.
You can also record the caller’s message into the Voice Memo list.
To listen to the message, see “Voice Memo Options” on page 127.
Activating Screen Call
TostartScreenCallwhenyouhaveincomingcalls:
1. When the phone rings or vibrates, press Options (right softkey)
to display the options.
2. Highlight ScreenCall and press
.
TosetAutoScreenCall:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select ScreenCall and press
.
4. Select Auto and press
.
5. Select On and press
.
6. Set the answering time by using numeric keys or by pressing the
navigation key up or down.
7. Press
or OK (left softkey). (The icon is displayed on the
standby display.)
Tip: If a new caller’s message is waiting, appears on the display. The memos
recorded while activating “Screen Call” are shown with “√” or “!” icon in the list
(“√”: once played, “!”: not played yet).
Tip: While the caller’s message is being recorded: Pressing
and disconnects the call, pressing answers the call.
stops recording
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
129
Selecting anAnnouncement for Screen Call
ToselectaScreenCallannouncement:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select ScreenCall and press
.
4. Select Announcement and press
5. Depending on your preference, highlight Pre-Recorded or
Custom and press
.
.
RecordingYourNameforaPre-RecordedAnnouncement
You can use a pre-recorded announcement with or without your
name. If you record your name, your phone uses your name to
announce that you are not available to answer the call.
Torecordyourname:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select ScreenCall and press
.
4. Select Announcement and press
.
5. Select Pre-Recorded and press Edit (right softkey).
6. Select RecordName and press
.
Ⅲ
If your name has already been recorded, select Yes or No to
overwrite the existing recording.
7. Press
to start the first recording. (Press
to stop recording.)
8. After the first recording, press
again to start the second
recording.
9. Press
to stop recording.
Tip: Recording terminates automatically after 12 seconds.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
130
Recording a CustomizedAnnouncement
Torecordanannouncement:
1. Follow steps 1-4 on the previous page.
2. Select Custom and press Edit (right softkey).
3. Highlight Record and press
.
Ⅲ
When an announcement has already been recorded, select
Yes or No to overwrite the existing recording.
4. Press
to start the first recording. (Press
to stop recording.)
5. After the first recording, press
again to start the second
recording.
6. Press
to stop recording.
Tip: Recording terminates automatically after 12 seconds.
Reviewing anAnnouncement
Toreviewanannouncement:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select VoiceServices and press
.
3. Select ScreenCall and press
.
4. Select Announcement and press
.
5. Select Pre-Recorded or Custom and press Edit (right softkey).
6. Highlight Play or Play:Speaker and press
.
Erasing anAnnouncement
Toeraseanannouncement:
1. Follow steps 1-5 above.
2. Select EraseName to erase the name for a Pre-Recorded
announcement and press
.
– or –
Select Erase to erase the message for a Custom announcement
and press
.
3. Select Yes and press
.
Section 2I: Using Your Phone’s Voice Services
131
Section 2J
Using PCS Ready Link
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ GettingStartedWithPCSReadyLink
MakingandReceivingaPCSReadyLinkCall
AddingandEditingReadyLinkContacts
ErasingReadyLinkListEntries
UpdatingYourPCSReadyLinkLists
ManagingPCSReadyLinkSettings
YourPCSVisionReadyLinkPhonegivesyoutheabilitytoquicklyconnect
withotherPCSReadyLinkusersforwalkie-talkie-stylecommunication
fromanywhere, toanywhereontheSprintNationwidePCSNetwork.
It’s ideal for quick two-way conversations with your friends, family,
and co-workers.
This section explains the features and options of your PCS Vision
Ready Link Phone.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
132
Getting StartedWith PCS Ready Link
PCS Ready Link allows you to enjoy quick, two-way, “walkie-talkie-style”
communication with your friends, family, and co-workers. You can
make 1-to-1 or 1-to-many calls (up to 5 others on the same call) to any
other PCS Ready Link user, anywhere on the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network. You can make and receive PCS Ready Link calls when
your phone displays
.
Setting PCS Ready Link Mode
ToenableordisablePCSReadyLinkmode:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select Enable/Disable and press
.
5. Select Enable and press . (The default setting is Disable.)
Ⅲ
Enable: Lets you make or receive PCS Ready Link calls any
time your phone is not in use.
Ⅲ
Disable: Disables your phone’s PCS Ready Link service; you
will not be able to make or receive PCS Ready Link calls or
access your Ready Link contacts.
Tip: If you haven’t signed up for the PCS Ready Link service and PCS Ready Link
mode is set to Disable, you can use the Ready Link (Memo) Button (
Voice Memo button in standby mode.
) as a
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
133
PreparingYour Phone for PCS Ready Link Service
The first time you use your PCS Vision Ready Link Phone, your phone
must identify itself and make itself available to the Ready Link network.
1. When you activate PCS Ready Link for the first time, you will be
prompted to activate Ready Link service. Press OK (left softkey)
to activate. (You will see “PreparingReadyLinkservice... Please
wait.”)
2. Press R-Link (left softkey) or the Ready Link (Memo) button on
the side of your phone (
). (The PCS Ready Link Help
message will appear.)
3. Press Yes (left softkey) to read a brief introduction to PCS Ready
Link, and press Next (left softkey) to continue through the tutorial.
Your phone is now ready to make and receive PCS Ready Link calls.
Ready Link Call Alerts
There are several ways your PCS Phone alerts you during PCS Ready
Link calls.
When you make or receive a PCS Ready Link call:
ⅷ
The phone sounds (depending on the Ringer Type and Ringer
Volume setting).
ⅷ
The backlight illuminates.
ⅷ
The screen displays a PCS Ready Link call message.
ⅷ
The other party’s PCS Ready Link number and name (if available)
are displayed.
ⅷ
The screen displays who has the floor.
The status of a PCS Ready Link call:
ⅷ
The Green LED On indicates you have the floor and may speak.
ⅷ
The Red LED On indicates another contact has the floor.
ⅷ
The LED Off indicates the floor is open. (You can take the floor
and speak by pressing and holding
.)
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
134
Making and Receiving a PCS Ready Link Call
Displaying the PCS Ready Link List
ᮣ
From standby mode, press R-Link (left softkey) or the Ready Link
(Memo) button on the side of your phone (
) to access the
PCS Ready Link List.
Selecting Contact Lists
When your phone displays a PCS Ready Link List, the left softkey is
labeled Goto. To switch to another contact list, press Goto (left
softkey), highlight your desired list, and press
.
ⅷ
CompanyList/CompanyGroups contain company-provided contacts
(up to 200 entries). Your company list can only be created and
modified by an authorized administrator on the PCS Ready Link
server. You cannot add, edit, or delete Company List items, but
you can copy entries to your Personal Lists.
ⅷ
PersonalList/PersonalGroups contain your personal Ready Link
contact names and numbers, separately or in groups. You can
create and edit your own Personal List. Your phone can store a
total of 200 entries (you may include up to five contacts per
group).
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
Outgoing shows the last 10 different PCS Ready Link calls you
placed.
Incoming shows the last 10 different PCS Ready Link calls you
accepted.
Missed shows the last 10 PCS Ready Link calls you missed.
Note: The
icon next to the group name indicates a group.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
135
MakingaPCSReadyLinkCall (1-to-1 Call)
You can place a 1-to-1 PCS Ready Link call by entering a PCS Ready
Link number or by selecting a contact from the PCS Ready Link List.
ToplaceaPCSReadyLinkcallbyselectingacontact:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight the list from which you want
to place a call (CompanyList, PersonalList, Outgoing, Incoming, or
Missed), and press
.
Tip: You can also select Enter R-Link# from the Go to option to enter a PCS Ready
Link number directly. (See page 138 for details.)
3. Highlight the contact you want to call, and press and hold
to place the call and get the floor. (You will see R-Linkcalling...
and Connecting... followed by “Youhavefloor.” You can now
begin speaking.)
– or –
Highlight the contact you want to call and press and release
to place the call. (The call will connect as described above,
but “Floorisopen.” will appear on the screen and either you or
your contact may press and hold
to take the floor and
speak.)
Ⅲ
To see an entry’s information, press
during step 3 above.
Note: During a PCS Ready Link call, the “floor” is the right to speak. When you see
“Floor is open.,” the first person to press the Ready Link (Memo) button ( ) can
speak (while holding the button). Only the person who has the floor can speak.
The phone beeps if you press the Ready Link (Memo) button when another
contact has the floor.
4. Continue holding
as you speak. When you are finished
speaking, release the Ready Link (Memo) button to allow other
contacts to speak. (When the other party takes the floor, you
will see the speaker’s name and phone number and the text
“hasfloor.”)
5. When you are finished, press
.
Note: When neither party has the floor during a PCS Ready Link call,
“Floor is open.” appears on the display. If no one takes the floor for 20 seconds,
the PCS Ready Link call ends automatically.
Tip: If you press
voice call.
or
during step 3 above, you can make a standard
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
136
Making a PCS Ready Link Call (Group Call)
You can make a PCS Ready Link call to all members in a Group entry,
which you have in your PCS Ready Link List. You can communicate
with up to five members at a time.
ToplaceaPCSReadyLinkGroupcall:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight the list from which you want
to make a Group call (CompanyGroups or PersonalGroups), and
press
.
3. Highlight the group you want to call, and press and hold
to
place the call and take the floor. (You will see R-Linkcalling... and
Connecting... followed by “Youhavefloor.” Continue with the
PCS Ready Link call as described on the previous page.)
Ⅲ
To display a group member’s details, press , highlight
your desired group member, then press View (left softkey)
during step 3 above. Press
to make a PCS Ready Link
call to the member.
Ⅲ
If one of the group members takes the floor, you will see the
member’s name and PCS Ready Link number on the display.
The phone beeps if you press the Ready Link (Memo)
button when another contact has the floor.
4. When the call is finished, press
.
Tip: You can also make a Group Call after checking the group member. Press
to display group members, highlight <Call Group> and press and hold
step 3 above.
during
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
137
Making a PCS Ready Link Call by Entering a Number
ToplaceaPCSReadyLinkcallbyenteringanumber:
1. From standby mode, enter the PCS Ready Link number you
want to dial.
2. Press
to place the PCS Ready Link call. Continue holding
to take the floor and speak.
Ⅲ
The contact’s name appears on the display if there is a
matched number in your PCS Ready Link List.
3. Continue with the PCS Ready Link call, pressing and holding
to speak and releasing it to allow others to reply.
4. When the call is finished, press
.
– or –
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight EnterR-Link# and press
3. Enter the PCS Ready Link number you want to dial.
4. Follow steps 2-4 above.
.
Note: PCS Ready Link numbers must contain ten digits (area code + phone
number). Your PCS Ready Link number is the same as your PCS Phone number.
Missed Call Notification for PCS Ready Link Calls
When an incoming PCS Ready Link call is not answered, the Missed
Call Notification is displayed on your screen.
TocallthelastMissedPCSReadyLinkcall:
ᮣ
Simply press and hold
while the Missed Call Notification is
displayed. (Continue with the PCS Ready Link call as described
previously.)
TodisplaytheMissedReadyLinkCallLog:
ᮣ
Press View (left softkey). To call the entry, highlight the entry
you want to call, and press and hold
. (Continue with the
PCS Ready Link call as described previously.)
Note: When you display Missed Calls entries, you will see the icon next to the
name. The icon will remain until you make or receive a PCS Ready Link call to
or from the entry. The
icon appears next to the new missed call entry.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
138
Receiving aPCSReadyLinkCall(1-to-1 Call)
1. Make sure your phone’s PCS Ready Link mode is enabled (see
“Setting PCS Ready Link Mode” on page 133).
2. When you receive a PCS Ready Link call from a contact, “R-Link
Call,” the contact’s name, and the PCS Ready Link number
appear on the display. (You do not need to take any action to
answer the call.)
3. If the person placing the call has kept the floor (held the
Ready Link [Memo] button), you will see the contact name and
PCS Ready Link number along with “hasfloor.”, and you will
hear the caller speaking.
4. When the caller finishes speaking and releases the Ready Link
(Memo) button, you will see “Floorisopen.” on the display
screen. Press and hold
to take the floor and reply to the
caller. (You will see “Youhavefloor.” and hear a tone confirming
that you may speak.)
5. When the conversation is finished, press
.
Receiving a PCS Ready Link Call (Group Call)
1. When you receive a PCS Ready Link call from one of the group
members, “Group Call,” the group member’s name, and the
PCS Ready Link number appear on the display.
2. Continue with the PCS Ready Link call as described previously.
3. When the conversation is finished, press
.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
139
Redialing a PCS Ready Link Call
You can redial to the last PCS Ready Link call that you dialed or
received (whichever was more recent).
ToredialaPCSReadyLinkcall:
1. From the PCS Ready Link List, highlight Redial, and press and
hold
.
Ⅲ
You will see R-Linkredialing... and Connecting... followed by
the text “Youhavefloor.”
2. Speak after the beep (keep pressing down
while you are
speaking). After speaking, release the button to allow others to
reply.
3. When you are finished, press
.
Note: You can change the volume and the speaker setting while a PCS Ready
Link call is activated. Volume: Adjust the voice volume by using the Side Volume
key or by pressing the navigation key up or down except when you are pressing
and holding
. Speaker: Switch the speaker on or off by pressing
.
PCS Ready Link Options
When you use PCS Ready Link, several user options are available by
pressing Options (right softkey). To select an option, highlight it and
press
.
ⅷ
Copy to copy a contact to the Personal List. CopyGroup appears
when you highlight a group. (This option doesn’t appear if the
entry is already in the Personal List or when you select Personal
List/Personal Groups.)
ⅷ
ⅷ
Edit to edit a PCS Ready Link number and/or name. See page 145.
Erase to erase a contact. EraseGroup appears when you highlight a
group.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
AddContact to add a new contact. AddGroup appears when you
highlight a group list. See page 143 for details.
EraseR-LinkList to erase entries saved in the PCS Ready Link List
(except Company List/Company Groups).
Help to see the PCS Ready Link instruction page.
Note: When you use additional accessories, the volume of Ready Link floor tones
is fixed as follows. Speaker/Car Kit: Level 3. Earpiece/Headset: Level 2.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
140
Adding and Editing Ready Link Contacts
CopyinganEntrytoPersonalListorPersonalGroupList
You can copy an entry to your Personal Lists from several different
sources. If the selected entry is already stored in the Personal Lists,
the “copy” option does not appear.
TocopyanentryfromthelastPCSReadyLinkcall:
1. From the PCS Ready Link List, highlight Redial and press
2. Press Copy (right softkey).
.
3. Press Yes (left softkey) to complete copying.
TocopyanentryfromthePCSReadyLinkList:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight the list from which you want
to copy a contact (CompanyList, CompanyGroups, Outgoing,
Incoming, or Missed), and press
.
3. Highlight the entry you want to copy (or scroll to highlight the
Redial entry at the top of your screen) and press Options (right
softkey).
4. Highlight Copy and press
.
Ⅲ
CopyGroup appears when you highlight a group during
step 3 above.
5. Press Yes (left softkey) to copy and save the entry to your
Personal List or Personal Group List.
TocopyanentryfromtheCompanyList:
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select Find/AddEntry and press
4. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight CompanyList, and press
5. Highlight a contact you want to copy and press Options (right
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
softkey). To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
CopytoPersonal to copy the entry to the Personal List.
Ⅲ
CopytoPh. Book to copy the entry to the Contacts list.
6. Press Yes (left softkey) to complete copying.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
141
TocopyanentryfromtheCompanyGroupList:
1. From step 4 on the previous page, highlight CompanyGroups and
press
.
2. Highlight a group you want to copy and press Options (right
softkey). To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
CopytoPersonal to copy the entry to your Personal Group List.
Ⅲ
Exit to exit the options.
3. Press Yes (left softkey) to complete copying.
Note: Your Company Lists can only be set up and edited by an authorized
administrator on the PCS Ready Link server. You cannot add or edit
contacts/groups to your Company Lists.
Saving a PCS Ready Link Number
When you have finished a PCS Ready Link call, you will see the
caller’s name, PCS Ready Link number, and the text “R-Link call
ended.” on the display. You can save a PCS Ready Link number from
the ending display to your Personal Lists.
Tosavethenumber:
1. From the ending display, press Save (right softkey).
2. Press Yes (left softkey).
Ⅲ
If the entry has no name, you are prompted to enter a name.
Note: If the number is already stored in the Personal List or Personal Groups, the
“Save” softkey does not appear.
Finding an Entry in the PCS Ready Link List
You can find your desired entry by entering a few letters.
TofindaPCSReadyLinkentry:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight your desired list (CompanyList,
CompanyGroups, PersonalList, or PersonalGroups), and press
.
3. Enter the first letter or the first few letters of the name.
Ⅲ
The display shows the list beginning with the letter(s) you
entered.
4. Scroll through the list and press
to select your desired entry.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
142
Adding a New Contact toYour Personal List
You can store a total of 200 entries in the Personal Lists.
ToaddanewPCSReadyLinkcontact:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight PersonalList, and press
.
3. Highlight <AddContact> and press
.
– or –
Highlight an entry and press Options (right softkey). Then
highlight AddContact and press
.
Ⅲ
If the Personal List is full, you will see a warning message on
the display. (Your phone can store a total of 200 Ready Link
Personal List or Personal Group contacts.)
4. Enter a name for the new contact and press . (This is the
name you will see when calling or receiving a call from the
contact.)
5. Highlight the R-LinkNumber field, enter the contact’s 10-digit
PCS Ready Link number (their PCS Phone number) and
press
.
6. Press Save (left softkey) to save the new contact to your
Personal List.
Tip: You are not allowed to use the following symbols during step 4: “:”, “@”, “;”,
“/”, “*”, “)”, and “(”.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
143
Adding a New Group toYour Personal Group List
You can add new groups to the Personal Group List. Each group can
include up to five members. You can enter a group member directly,
or select the member from the Company List or Personal List.
ToaddanewPCSReadyLinkgroupentry:
1. Press R-Link (left softkey) or press
to access the PCS Ready
Link List.
2. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight PersonalGroups, and press
.
3. Highlight <AddGroup> and press
.
– or –
Highlight an entry and press Options (right softkey). Then
highlight AddGroup and press
.
4. Enter a Group Name, press , and press Next (left softkey).
5. To add contacts to the group, press Add (right softkey).
6. Highlight one item from the following and press
:
Ⅲ
New to add a new contact. See the previous page for details.
fromCompany to add a contact from your Company List.
fromPersonal to add a contact from your Personal List.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
7. Scroll to select the contacts you want to add and press
or
Pick (right softkey) to include the entries.
8. Press Done (left softkey) when you are finished selecting
contacts, then press Update (left softkey) to update your
Personal Group List with the new group entry.
Tip: You can also add members directly. From step 5 above, highlight
<Add Members> and press . Enter the new member’s name and R-Link number
and press Save (left softkey) to save the entry.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
144
Editing a Contact inYour Personal List
ToeditaPersonalListcontact:
1. Follow steps 1-2 in “Adding a New Contact to Your Personal
List” on page 143.
2. Highlight the entry you want to edit and press Options (right
softkey).
Ⅲ
Edit to edit the selected contact.
Ⅲ
Erase to erase the selected contact.
Ⅲ
AddContact to add a new contact.
Ⅲ
EraseR-LinkList to erase the PCS Ready Link List.
See page 147 for details.
Ⅲ
Help to view the PCS Ready Link instruction page.
3. Highlight Edit and press
4. Highlight the field you want to edit (Name or R-LinkNumber),
and press
.
.
5. Edit the entry, press OK (left softkey), and press Save (left
softkey) to save your changes.
Editing a Group inYour Personal Group List
Toeditagroupname:
1. Follow steps 1-2 in “Adding a New Group to Your Personal
Group List” on the previous page.
2. Highlight the group entry you want to edit and press Options
(right softkey).
Ⅲ
Edit to edit the selected group.
Ⅲ
EraseGroup to erase the selected group.
Ⅲ
AddGroup to add a new group.
Ⅲ
EraseR-LinkList to erase the PCS Ready Link List.
See page 147 for details.
Ⅲ
Help to view the PCS Ready Link instruction page.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
145
3. Highlight Edit and press
.
4. Edit the group name and press
or OK (left softkey).
Ⅲ
If you don’t need to edit the group name, press Next (left
softkey) during step 4 above and skip step 5.
5. Press Save (left softkey) to save your changes.
6. To edit a group member, highlight the contact you want to edit
and press Options (right softkey).
Ⅲ
Edit to edit a group member’s name and phone number.
Ⅲ
Erase to erase the group member.
Ⅲ
AddNew to add a new group member in the Personal Group
List.
Ⅲ
Add(Company) to add a new group member from the
Company List.
Ⅲ
Add(Personal) to add a new group member from the
Personal List.
Ⅲ
Details to display a group member’s information.
7. Highlight Edit and press
8. Highlight the field you want to edit (Name or R-LinkNumber) and
press
.
.
9. Edit the entry, press OK (left softkey), and press Save (left
softkey) to save your changes.
10. Press Update (left softkey) to update your Personal Group List.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
146
Erasing Ready Link List Entries
Erasing an Entry inYour Personal List or Personal
Group List
Toeraseacontactoragroup:
1. From the PCS Ready Link List, press Goto (left softkey),
highlight PersonalList or PersonalGroups, and press
.
2. Highlight the entry you want to erase and press Options (right
softkey).
3. Highlight Erase and press
.
Ⅲ
EraseGroup appears when you select Personal Groups.
4. Select Yes and press
Toeraseagroupmember:
1. From the PCS Ready Link List, press Goto (left softkey),
.
highlight PersonalGroups, and press
.
2. Highlight your desired group and press
to display the group
members.
3. Highlight the contact you want to erase and press Options (right
softkey).
4. Highlight Erase and press
5. Select Yes and press
.
.
6. Press Update (left softkey) to update your Personal Group List.
Erasing a PCS Ready Link List
You can erase all entries saved in the PCS Ready Link List (except
Company List/Company Groups).
ToeraseaPCSReadyLinkList:
1. From the PCS Ready Link List, press Options (right softkey).
2. Highlight EraseR-LinkList and press
.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
147
3. Highlight your desired option and press
.
Ⅲ
Outgoing to erase all outgoing PCS Ready Link calls.
Incoming to erase all incoming PCS Ready Link calls.
Missed to erase all missed PCS Ready Link calls.
All to erase all PCS Ready Link call history, except redial.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
AllPersonalEnt. to erase all entries in Personal List and
Personal Groups. You are prompted to enter your 4-digit
lock code. (See “Unlocking Your Phone” on page 66.)
4. Select Yes and press
.
Tip: The Redial number will not be erased.
UpdatingYour PCS Ready Link Lists
Updating the Company List and Personal List
ToupdateyourCompanyListandPersonalListmanuallythrough
thePCSReadyLinkserver:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select ReadyLink and press
4. Select ListUpdate and press
.
.
.
Managing PCS Ready Link Settings
Setting Speed Dialing for PCS Ready Link Entries
TosetSpeedDialingforPCSReadyLinkentries:
1. Press
2. Select Contacts and press
3. Select SpeedDial#s and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
4. Highlight an unassigned number and press
.
Ⅲ
When you highlight an assigned number and press
,
you’ll be asked whether you want to overwrite the assigned
number. Select Yes or No, or you can also select Unassign to
cancel the stored speed dial.
5. Press Goto (left softkey), highlight the list from which you want
to set a speed dial (CompanyList, CompanyGroups, PersonalList,
or PersonalGroups) and press
.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
148
6. Select the contact and press
.
– or –
Select the group and press , select an option, and press
.
Ⅲ
Assign to assign the selected group as a speed dial.
Ⅲ
Details to display the group details. You can select the entry
from the group list.
TouseSpeedDialforaPCSReadyLinkentry:
ᮣ
From standby mode, press the appropriate key and press and
hold
.
Restarting the Ready Link Service
TorestartthePCSReadyLinkservice:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select RestartR-Link and press
.
Setting Ready Link Guard
This feature enables you to display the warning message when you
cannot receive PCS Ready Link calls. The warning message will
appear when you are launching a Web or Java application, or
sending/uploading your pictures.
TosettheReadyLinkGuard:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select R-LinkGuard and press . (A message will appear.)
5. Press OK (left softkey) to continue.
6. Select On and press
.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 6 above.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
149
Setting RingerTypes for PCS Ready Link Calls
Your PCS Vision Phone provides a variety of ringer types that allow
you to customize your ringer and volume settings.
ToselectaringertypeforPCSReadyLinkcalls:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select ReadyLink and press
4. Select RingerType and press
.
.
.
5. Select the menu under ReadyLinkCalls and press
.
6. Select your desired ringer type and press
.
Ⅲ
To confirm the ringer, press Play (right softkey).
Tip: You can also change the ringer type from the Settings menu (see “Selecting
Ringer Types for PCS Ready Link Calls” on page 37).
Setting an Alert Notification for PCS Ready Link Calls
Your PCS Phone can alert you with an audible tone when you receive
a PCS Ready Link call.
TosetalertsforPCSReadyLinkcalls:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select Alerts and press
.
5. Select Once or RepeatAlert and press
.
Tip: You can also set alerts from the Settings menu (see “Alert Notification” on
page 42).
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
150
Setting the Speakerphone for PCS Ready Link Calls
You can set the speakerphone on or off when PCS Ready Link call is
activated. By default, the speakerphone is set to on.
Tosetthespeakerphoneonoroff:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select Speakerphone and press
5. Select On or Off and press
Note: If the phone’s ringer volume is set to Vibrate, Ringer off, or Silence All, the
.
.
speakerphone turns off. Press to turn the speakerphone mode on.
Setting the DefaultView of the PCS Ready Link List
You can select the default PCS Ready Link List when PCS Ready Link
is launched.
ToselectthedefaultviewofthePCSReadyLinkList:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select ReadyLink and press
.
4. Select DefaultView and press . (The default setting is
CompanyList.)
5. Select your desired list and press
.
Note: If there are no data in the Company lists, your phone will display your
Personal List.
Section 2J: Using PCS Ready Link
151
Section 2K
Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ TakingPictures
SM
SendingPictureMail
StoringPicturesinMyPictures
SM
ManagingPictureMail
YourPCSVisionPicturePhone’sbuilt-incameragivesyoutheabilityto
takefull-colordigitalpictures, view your pictures using the phone’s
display, and instantly send them to your family and friends. It’s fun
and as easy to use as a traditional point-and-click camera: just take a
picture, view it on your phone’s display, and send it from your
phone to up to ten people.
This section explains the features and options of your PCS Vision
Picture Phone’s built-in camera.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
152
Taking Pictures
Taking pictures with your phone’s built-in camera is as simple as
choosing a subject, pointing the lens, and pressing a button. You can
activate camera mode and take pictures whether the phone is open
or closed.
Totakeapicturewiththephoneopen:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Pictures and press
to access the Pictures menu.
to activate camera mode.
3. Select Camera and press
(Additional user options are available through the camera mode
Options menu. See “Camera Mode Options” on page 155 for
more information.)
Shortcut: To activate camera mode, you can also press and hold
camera key (see illustration on page 10).
or the side
4. Using the phone’s main LCD as a viewfinder, aim the camera
lens at your subject.
5. To take the picture, press
,
, Capture (left softkey), or the
Side Camera key. (The picture will be saved automatically in
your In Camera folder.)
Ⅲ
To return to camera mode to take another picture, press
.
6. Press Next (right softkey) to go to the next step.
Steps:
ⅷ
SendPicture to send the picture. (See page 162 for details.)
ⅷ
Upload to upload the picture you just took to the Picture Mail
Website. Depending on your settings, you may be prompted to
accept a PCS Vision connection.
ⅷ
SetasPictureID to assign the picture as a Picture ID.
ⅷ
SetasScrnSaver to assign the picture as a Screen Saver.
ⅷ
GotoCamera to return to camera mode to take another picture.
ⅷ
Picsincamera to go to the In Camera folder to review your saved
pictures.
ⅷ
Delete to delete the picture you just took.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
153
Totakeapicturewiththephoneclosed:
1. Press and hold the side camera key to activate camera mode.
2. Point the camera lens at your subject. (You can check the
picture framing through the Sub LCD.)
Note: When taking a picture with the phone closed, the subject image appears in
reverse on the external display. The captured image will not be saved in reverse.
3. Press the side camera key to take the picture. (The picture will
be saved automatically in your In Camera folder.)
Ⅲ
Open the flip to review the picture and go to the next step.
Note: While you are taking a picture, the backlight turns on even if your backlight
is set to Always Off.
Note: In some cases, the screen may flicker and the stripes may appear on the
display under fluorescent lighting.
SM
CreatingYour Picture Mail Password
The first time you use any of the Picture Mail management options
involving the Picture Mail Website, you will need to establish a
Picture Mail password through your PCS Vision Picture Phone. This
password will also allow you to sign in to the Picture Mail Website at
picturemail.sprintpcs.com to access and manage your uploaded pictures
and albums.
TocreateyourPictureMailpassword:
1. Press
2. Select Pictures and press
3. Select OnlineAlbums and press
to access the main menu.
to access the Pictures menu.
.
4. Select ViewAlbums and press . (You will be prompted to
create a pictures password.)
Note: If your PCS Service Plan does not include Picture Mail, you will first be
prompted to subscribe to the service for an additional monthly charge.
5. Enter a four- to eight-digit password and press
or OK (left
softkey).
6. Please wait while the system creates your account.
Tip: Write down your Picture Mail password in a secure place.
Once your account has been successfully registered, you may upload
and send pictures and access the Picture Mail Website.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
154
Camera Mode Options
When the phone is open and in camera mode, several user options
are available.
Press Options (right softkey) to display additional user options:
ⅷ
Flash to activate the flash function. (See “Setting the Flash
Function” on the next page for details.)
ⅷ
Self-timer to activate the camera’s timer function. (See “Setting
the Self-timer” on the next page for details.)
ⅷ
FunTools to select an option from the following:
Ⅲ
FunFrames to select your favorite fun picture frame to
decorate your picture.
Ⅲ
MultipleShots to take multiple shots. (See “Taking Multiple
Shots” on page 157 for details.)
Ⅲ
ColorTone to select a wide variety of color tones for the
picture (Normal, Sepia, Black&White, Negative, Posterization
or Emboss).
ⅷ
ImageControls to select an option from the following:
Ⅲ
Brightness to select Auto or Manual brightness control. If you
select Manual, press the navigation key right (increase) or
left (decrease) to select a setting and press
to apply the
desired setting.
Ⅲ
WhiteBalance to adjust white balance based on changing
conditions. Select from Auto, Sunny, Cloudy, Tungsten,
Fluorescent, or Manual.
ⅷ
ⅷ
CameraSettings to select Resolution, Quality, ShutterSound,
StatusArea, or AutoDelete. (See “Selecting Camera Settings” on
page 159 for details.)
Picsincamera to go to your phone’s In Camera folder. (See “In
Camera Folder” on page 165 for details.)
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
155
SettingtheFlashFunction
Toactivatetheflashfunction:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Select Flash and press
.
3. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
OnThisShot to activate the flash for one shot.
Ⅲ
OnAlways to activate the flash all the time.
Ⅲ
Auto to activate the flash automatically.
4. Take a picture using the phone’s main LCD as a viewfinder.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select Off during step 3.
Tip: When the phone is open and in camera mode, press
between flash modes.
to switch
SettingtheSelf-timer
ToactivatetheSelf-timer:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight Self-timer and press
3. Highlight the length of delay you want the timer to use
(10seconds or 5seconds) and press
4. Press Start (left softkey) when you are ready to start the timer.
appears on the lower left portion of the main LCD during
.
.
(
the Self-timer countdown.)
5. Get ready for the picture. (When the timer is down to three
seconds, the Self-timer icon will turn red and the phone will
begin to beep.)
Note: After taking a picture, Self-timer settings return to their default settings.
TocanceltheSelf-timerafterithasstarted:
ᮣ
Press Cancel (right softkey).
Note: While the Self-timer is active, all keys are disabled except
Cancel (right softkey).
,
, and
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
156
TakingMultipleShots
This feature allows you to take up to 8 continuous shots of one
moment. When you take multiple shots, will appear in the
viewfinder.
Totakemultipleshots:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Highlight FunTools and press
3. Highlight MultipleShots and press
Note: If your phone’s memory is full, the “Multiple Shots”option will not appear.
.
.
4. Select your desired option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
2Shots to take series of 2 shots.
Ⅲ
4Shots to take series of 4 shots. (Only appears when the
reslolution setting is Low or Medium.)
Ⅲ
8Shots to take series of 8 shots. (Only appears when the
reslolution setting is Low.)
5. Select the duration of the interval between shots from
Normal or Fast and press
.
6. To take the pictures, press . (The Multiple Shots folder will
display, up to four thumbnail pictures per screen.)
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature,select Off during step 4 above.
Tip: After taking multiple shots, the pictures are automatically saved in the
In Camera folder. (See “In Camera Folder” on page 165 for details.)
When you are in Multiple Shots folder,several user options are
available.
Press Options (right softkey) to display the following options:
ⅷ
Upload to upload pictures saved in your phone to the Picture Mail
Website.
ⅷ
SetasPictureID to display the picture as a Picture ID.
ⅷ
SetasScrnSaver to display the picture as a screen saver.
ⅷ
GotoCamera to activate camera mode.
ⅷ
Picsincamera to access the In Camera folder.
ⅷ
Delete to delete pictures in the In Camera folder.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
157
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
Slideshow to display your pictures as a slideshow. (Only appears
when you have two or more pictures in the folder.)
InfoBar to display information on the currently highlighted
picture. (Expanded picture only)
Thumbnail/Expand to switch the display from full-screen to
thumbnail view (up to four pictures per screen).
UsingtheZoomFunction
This feature allows you to zoom in on an object when you take a
picture. Depending on your resolution settings, you can adjust the
zoom from 1-step to 20-step.
Tousethezoomfunction:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press the navigation
key right or left to adjust the zoom. (The zoom icon changes as
you press.)
2. Press
to take the picture. (The picture will be saved
automatically in your In Camera folder.)
Note: The Zoom icons will not appear when the Resolution setting is High.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
158
Selecting Camera Settings
Toselectyourcamerasettings:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Select CameraSettings and press
.
3. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
Resolution to select a file size (High, Medium, or Low) for a
picture.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Quality to select Economy, Normal, or Fine picture quality.
ShutterSound to select a shutter sound. (See “Setting the
Shutter Sound” below for details.)
Ⅲ
StatusArea to select a picture status display setting. Select
Off to hide picture status, such as icons and number of
captured pictures. To display the status, select On.
(See “Viewing Your Camera’s Status Area Display” on the
next page for details.)
Ⅲ
AutoDelete to set the auto delete function. (See “Setting the
Auto Delete Function” on the next page for details.)
SettingtheShutterSound
ToselecttheShutterSound:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Select CameraSettings and press
.
3. Select ShutterSound and press
.
4. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
Default plays the default shutter sound.
Ⅲ
Say“Cheez” plays a recording of the phrase “Say Cheez.”
Off makes no sound.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
RecordYourOwn allows you to record your own voice.
Press
to display options, highlight Record and press
.
Press
to start recording. (Maximum recording time is
5 seconds.) To save the recording, press Save (right
softkey).
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
159
SettingtheAutoDeleteFunction
With this feature, pictures which have been uploaded to your online
Picture Mail account will be erased automatically from your phone.
TosettheAutoDeletefunction:
1. With the phone open and in camera mode, press Options (right
softkey).
2. Select CameraSettings and press
3. Select AutoDelete and press
.
.
4. Select Yes and press
to activate the auto delete function.
Ⅲ
To deactivate this feature, select No during step 4 above.
Note: The locked pictures will not be deleted automatically.
ViewingYour Camera’s StatusArea Display
CameraStatusArea
( V i e w f i n d e r )
Brightness
Zoom
White Balance
Multiple Shots
Self-Timer
Flash
Resolution
Memory Gauge
Capture
Options
Camera Status Area
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
160
IconIndication
No.
Function
Icons
Details
To use a flash only one shot after setting
this function.
OnThis Shot
On Always
Auto
To use a flash every time you take a picture.
To use the auto flash function.
Flash
1
Use this setting for sunny weather.
Use this setting for cloudy weather.
Use this setting for tungsten lighting.
Use this setting for fluorescent lighting.
Sunny
Cloudy
White
Tungsten
Fluorescent
Manual
Manual
1 step
2
3
4
Balance
For the manual setting of white balance.
For the manual setting of brightness.
Brightness
Zoom
For 1-step zoom. Appears when the
resolution setting is Medium or Low.
For 2-step zoom. Appears when the
resolution setting is Medium or Low.
2 step
For 8-step zoom. Appears when the
resolution setting is Low.
8 step
For 8-step zoom. Appears when the
resolution setting is Medium.
For 20-step zoom. Appears when the
resolution setting is Low.
20 step
Use this setting for Multiple Shots.
Shows the remaining memory.
The number of stored pictures.
Multiple Shots
5
6
Memory Gauge
Picture Number
Remaining Pictures
The count of pictures you can take with
current resolution.
Use this setting for self portralts.
Numeric countdown will appear during
the self-timer countdown.
Self-timer
5s
7
8
For high picture resolution.
For medium picture resolution.
For low picture resolution.
High
Resolution Medium
Low
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
161
SM
Sending Picture Mail
Once you’ve taken a picture, you can use the messaging capabilities
of your PM-8200 by Sanyo to instantly send it to family and friends.
You can send a picture to up to ten people at a time using their email
addresses or their PCS Vision Phone numbers.
Sending Picture Mail From the In Camera Folder
TosendPictureMailfromtheInCamerafolder:
1. With the clamshell open, press
to access the Pictures menu.
2. Select MyPictures and press
.
3. Select InCamera and press
.
4. Press to select a picture. (The check box on the lower right
corner will be marked. You can select multiple pictures.)
If there is no selected picture, the currently highlighted picture
will be selected.
5. Press Send (left softkey).
6. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
FromPhoneBook to select a recipient from your Contacts list.
Highlight a recipient and press to select.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
MobilePhone# to enter a mobile phone number directly.
EmailAddress to enter an email address directly.
Note: If there are no entries in your contact list, you will be prompted to enter
either an email address or a mobile phone number.
Note: The
and
icons next to contact’s names represent Mobile Phone
M
@
and email. When entering a new contact, use your navigation key to select the
correct icon for the entry. You can also select both the mobile phone number and
M
email address at once by selecting
icon.
@
7. Press Next (left softkey) when you are finished
selecting/entering recipients. (You may include up to ten
recipients per Picture Mail.)
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
162
8. If you wish to record and include a Voice Memo with the picture
you are sending, highlight the box under VoiceMemo and press
Record (right softkey). Press
to start recording. (Maximum
recording time is 10 seconds.)
9. If you wish to enter a text message, highlight the box under
Message and press Change (right softkey). Enter your message
using your keypad (or press Mode [right softkey] to select from
PresetMessages or RecentMessages) and press
.
(See “Entering Text” on page 31.)
10. Confirm the recipients, message, voice memo, and picture.
Ⅲ
To change a recipient, highlight the recipient, press Change
(right softkey), and follow the instructions in step 6 on the
previous page to select or edit the recipient.
Ⅲ
To change Voice Memo, highlight the box beneath
VoiceMemo and press Options (right softkey) to display
options:
VoiceMemoPlay to play the attached voice memo.
VoiceMemoRec to re-record the voice memo.
VoiceMemoErase to delete the voice memo from the
Picture Mail.
Ⅲ
To change the attached message, highlight the box beneath
Message and press Change (right softkey).
Ⅲ
To change the attached pictures, select a thumbnail picture
using your navigation key and press Change (right softkey).
Select an alternate picture and press , then press Next
(left softkey).
11. Press Send (left softkey) to send the Picture Mail.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
163
Sending Picture Mail from Messaging
You can also send your pictures from your phone’s Messaging menu.
TosendPictureMailfromtheMessagingmenu:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
to access the Messaging menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
Shortcut: Press the navigation key up from standby mode to access the
Messaging menu.
3. Select PictureMail and press
.
4. Select SendPicture and press
.
5. Select FromMyPics. and press . (The In Camera folder will
display, up to four thumbnail pictures per screen.)
6. Use the navigation key to display the picture you wish to send
and press . (You can select multiple pictures.)
Tip: To expand a selected picture from thumbnail to full-screen, press and hold
.
7. Press Next (left softkey). To complete and send the Picture Mail,
follow steps 6-11 in “Sending Picture Mail From the In Camera
Folder” on page 162.
Tip: If you want to take a new picture and send it, select Take Picture during
step 5 above. Take the new picture, press Next (right softkey) and follow
steps 6-11 in “Sending Picture Mail From the In Camera Folder”on page 162.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
164
Storing Pictures in My Pictures
My Pictures is your phone’s picture storage area. There are two types
of folders in My Pictures that can be used separately according to
your needs. They are:
ⅷ
InCameraFolder (see below)
ⅷ
SavedtoPhoneFolder (see page 168)
In Camera Folder
Once a picture is taken, it is automatically saved to the folder called
“In Camera.” You can enter the In Camera folder from MyPictures
menu by selecting InCamera. From the In Camera folder, you can
view all the pictures you have taken, store selected images in your
phone, send pictures to the Picture Mail Website, delete images, and
access additional picture options.
ToreviewyourstoredpicturesintheInCamerafolder:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Pictures and press
to access the Pictures menu.
.
3. Select MyPictures and press
4. Select InCamera and press . (Thumbnail pictures will display,
up to four pictures at a time.)
5. Use your navigation key to view and scroll through pictures.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
165
In Camera Folder Options
When you are in the In Camera folder, several user options are available.
Press Options (right softkey) to display the following options:
ⅷ
Upload to select an option from the following to upload pictures
saved in your phone to the Picture Mail Website. Depending on
your settings, you may be prompted to accept a PCS Vision
connection.
Ⅲ
ThisPicture to upload the currently highlighted picture.
Ⅲ
SelectedPictures to upload the selected pictures. Press
select a picture (the check box on the lower right corner
will be marked).
to
Ⅲ
AllPictures to upload all the pictures in your phone.
Note: Erasing pictures will free up memory space in your phone to enable you to
take more pictures. Once erased, pictures cannot be uploaded to your online
Picture Mail account or saved to the Saved to Phone folder.
ⅷ
SetasPictureID to display the currently highlighted picture for
incoming calls from a specific Contacts List entry. Select your
desired entry and press
.
ⅷ
ⅷ
SetasScrnSaver to display the currently highlighted picture as a
screen saver.
Details/Edit to display the currently highlighted picture’s details or
edit the pictures. You can select from TextCaption, PictureInfo,
ColorTone, or RotatePicture.
ⅷ
Delete to delete pictures in the In Camera folder. Select ThisPicture,
SelectedPictures, or AllPictures.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
Lock to lock your picture to protect from unintentional deletion.
Unlock to unlock your picture.
SavetoPhone to save the selected images in the Saved to Phone
folder.
ⅷ
ⅷ
SortbyDate to sort pictures by date. (Thumbnail picture only.)
Select Taken-Descending, Taken-Ascending, Uploaded-Descend, or
Uploaded-Ascend.
Slideshow to display your pictures as a slideshow. (Only appears
when you have two or more pictures in the folder.)
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
166
ⅷ
InfoBar to display information on the selected picture, such as
folder name, picture number, caption, etc. Select On to display
the caption of a picture; select Off to hide the information.
(Expanded picture only.)
Tip: From expanded picture display, press the navigation key up or down to hide
or display the Info Bar.
ⅷ
Thumbnail/Expand to switch the display from full-screen to
thumbnail view (up to four pictures per screen).
ⅷ
GotoSavedtoPh. to access the Saved to Phone folder.
ⅷ
GotoCamera to activate camera mode.
Note: Save to Phone and Upload copy pictures from your phone’s In Camera
folder to your Saved to Phone folder or your online Picture Mail account.
Pictures that have been stored to your Saved to Phone folder or uploaded to your
online account will remain available in the In Camera folder until you erase them.
Note: If this is the first time you have accessed the Picture Mail account, you will
be prompted to create your Picture Mail password. (See “Creating Your Picture
Mail Password” on page 154.)
InCameraFolder
Folder name
Uploaded icon
Locked icon
Count of Saved Pictures
Current Picture number
In Camera
1/6
(View 1)
Latest
(View 2)
2nd latest
Check Box
(View 3)
3rd latest
(View 4)
4th latest
Caption
left softkey
Title-1
Send
Options
right softkey
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
167
Saved to Phone Folder
When you assign or download a picture, the picture will be saved
automatically to the separate folder called “Saved to Phone.”
The Saved to Phone folder allows you to store copies of pictures on
your phone and to assign pictures to various phone tasks.
TosaveapicturetotheSavedtoPhonefolder:
1. From the In Camera folder (see “In Camera Folder” on page 165),
select a picture you wish to save to the Saved to Phone folder
and press . (You may select multiple pictures.)
2. Press Options (right softkey). (The In Camera folder options will
display.)
3. Select SavetoPhone and press . (A copy of the picture will be
saved to the Saved to Phone folder.)
ToviewpicturesstoredintheSavedtoPhonefolder:
1. Press
2. Select Pictures and press
Shortcut: Instead of steps 1 and 2 above, press
to access the main menu.
.
.
3. Select MyPictures and press
.
4. Select SavedtoPhone and press . (Thumbnail pictures will
display, up to four pictures at a time.)
5. Use your navigation key to view and scroll through pictures.
6. To expand the selected picture, press Expand (left softkey).
Tip: From expanded view, press and hold the navigation key right or left to display
the stored picture continuously.
7. Press Options (right softkey) to display a list of options for the
selected picture. To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
SetasPictureID to display the currently highlighted picture
for incoming calls from a specific Contacts List entry.
Ⅲ
SetasScrnSaver to display the currently highlighted picture
as a screen saver.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
168
Ⅲ
Details/Edit to display the currently highlighted picture’s
details or edit the pictures. You can select from TextCaption,
PictureInfo, ColorTone, or RotatePicture.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Delete to delete pictures stored in the Saved to Phone folder.
Select ThisPicture, SelectedPictures, or AllPictures.
Lock to lock your picture to protect from unintentional
deletion.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Unlock to unlock your picture.
SortbyDate to sort pictures by date. (Thumbnail picture only.)
Select Saved-Descending, or Saved-Ascending.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Slideshow to display your pictures as a slideshow. (Only
appears when you have two or more pictures in the folder.)
InfoBar to display information on the currently highlighted
picture, such as folder name, picture number, caption, etc.
(Expanded picture only.)
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Picsincamera to access the In Camera folder.
GotoCamera to activate camera mode.
Note: Pictures may be assigned to more than one task.
Note: Assigned pictures will be identified with the
.
SavedToPhoneFolder
Folder name
Assigned icon
Locked icon
Count of Saved Pictures
Current Picture number
Saved toPhone 1/6
(View 1)
Latest
(View 2)
2nd latest
Check Box
(View 3)
3rd latest
(View 4)
4th latest
Caption
left softkey
Title-1
Expand
Options
right softkey
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
169
Managing Picture Mail
Using the Picture MailWebsite
Once you have uploaded pictures from your phone to your online
Picture Mail account (see “In Camera Folder” on page 165), you can
use your personal computer to manage your pictures. From the
Picture Mail Website you can send pictures, edit album titles and
picture captions, organize and move images, and do much more.
You will also have access to picture management tools to improve
and customize your pictures. You’ll be able to lighten, darken, crop,
add antique effects, add comic bubbles and cartoon effects, and use
other features to transform your pictures.
ToaccessthePictureMailWebsite:
1. From your computer’s Internet connection, go to
2. Enter your PCS Phone Number and Picture Mail password to sign
on. (See “Creating Your Picture Mail Password” on page 154.)
Managing Online Picture Mail FromYour
PCSVision Phone
You can use your phone to manage, edit, or send pictures you have
uploaded to the Picture Mail Website. (See “In Camera Folder
Options” on page 166 for information about uploading.)
ToviewyouronlinePictureMailfromyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. Press
2. Select Pictures and press
Shortcut: Instead of steps 1 and 2 above, press
to access the main menu.
to access the Pictures menu.
.
3. Select OnlineAlbums and press
.
4. Select ViewAlbums and press . (Depending on your settings
you may be prompted to accept a PCS Vision connection.)
(The Uploads folder and your albums will appear.)
5. Highlight Uploads or an album title and press
to display.
(Thumbnail pictures, up to four per screen are displayed.)
Tip: To expand a selected picture from thumbnail to full-screen, press and hold
.
6. Use your navigation key to select a picture.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
170
UploadingYour Pictures
Touploadpictures:
1. Press
to access the Pictures menu.
2. Select OnlineAlbums and press
3. Select UploadPics and press
.
.
4. Use your navigation key to select a picture, and press Upload
(left softkey).
5. Select an option from the following and press
.
Ⅲ
ThisPicture to upload the currently highlighted picture.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
SelectedPictures to upload the selected pictures. Press
select a picture (the check box on the lower right corner
will be marked).
to
AllPictures to upload all the pictures in your phone.
Sending Online Picture Mail
TosendpicturesfromtheonlineAddressBook:
1. From the online Picture Mail display, select a picture you wish
to send and press Send (left softkey). (See “Managing Online
Picture Mail From Your PCS Vision Phone” on the previous page.)
2. Select OnlineAddr. Book and press
.
3. To select a recipient, highlight a recipient and press
.
(You may select up to 10 recipients.)
4. Press Done (left softkey) when you are finished selecting
recipients.
5. To complete and send the Picture Mail, follow steps 8-11 in
“Sending Picture Mail From the In Camera Folder” on page 163.
Tosendanalbumfromonlinemode:
1. From the online Albums display, select an album you wish to
send and press Send (left softkey). (See “Managing Online
Picture Mail From Your PCS Vision Phone” on the previous page.)
2. Follow steps 2-5 above to complete and send your Picture Mail.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
171
Accessing Online Picture Mail Options FromYour
PCSVision Phone
1. Select a picture from your online Picture Mail (see “Managing
Online Picture Mail From Your PCS Vision Phone” on page 170).
2. Press Options (right softkey) to display options.
3. To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
Copy/Move to copy or move pictures to a selected album:
MoveThis to move the currently highlighted picture to
the album.
MoveSelection to move the selected pictures to the album.
MoveAll to move all pictures in the current album
(or Uploads) to the target album.
CopyThis to copy the currently highlighted picture to the
album.
CopySelection to copy the selected pictures to the album.
CopyAll to copy all pictures in the current album
(or Uploads) to the target album.
Tip: Press New (right softkey) to copy/move pictures to a new folder.
Ⅲ
Details/Edit toselectTextCaption,PictureInfo, orRotatePicture.
TextCaption to edit the caption of a currently highlighted
picture.
PictureInfo to display information on the currently
highlighted picture, such as caption, time/date, size, etc.
RotatePicture to rotate the currently highlighted picture.
After selecting this option, you can rotate the currently
highlighted picture by pressing the navigation key right
or left, or Rotate (right softkey).
Ⅲ
Delete to select ThisPicture, SelectedPictures, or AllPictures
to erase a single picture, selected pictures, or all pictures
saved in the current album (or Uploads).
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
172
Ⅲ
SavetoPhone to download to the Saved to Phone folder to
assign the pictures to the phone task.
asPictureID to display the currently highlighted picture
for incoming calls from a specific Contacts List entry.
asScreenSaver to display the currently highlighted
picture as a screen saver.
DownloadOnly to only download the picture to the Saved
to Phone folder.
Ⅲ
InfoBar to display picture’s information, such as folder
name, picture number, caption, etc. Select On to display the
information; select Off to hide the information. (Expanded
picture only.)
Tip: From expanded picture display, press the navigation key up or down to hide
or display the Info Bar.
Ⅲ
Thumbnail/Expand to switch the display from thumbnail view
(up to four pictures per screen) to full-screen.
Ⅲ
CreateAlbum to create a new album (from Uploads only).
Enter the album name and select Save (left softkey).
Ⅲ
OnlineAlbums to switch the display to the online album list.
ToaccessyouronlineAlbumsoptionsfromyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. Display the album list in the online Picture Mail menu (see
“Managing Online Picture Mail From Your PCS Vision Phone”
on page 170).
2. Use your navigation key to select an album (or Uploads).
3. Press Options (right softkey) to display options.
4. To select an option, highlight it and press
.
Ⅲ
CreateAlbum to create a new album. Enter a new album
name and press Save (left softkey).
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
DeleteAlbum to delete the selected album.
Rename Album to rename the selected album. Enter a new
name and press Save (left softkey).
Note: Uploads cannot be erased or renamed.
Ⅲ
AlbumInfo to display album information:name, created
time/date, and the number of stored pictures.
Section 2K: Using Your Phone’s Built-in Camera
173
Section 3
PCS Service Features
Section 3A
PCS Service Features: The Basics
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ UsingVoicemail
UsingCallerID
RespondingtoCallWaiting
MakingaThree-WayCall
UsingCallForwarding
Nowthatyou’vemasteredyourphone’sfundamentals, it’stimetoexplore
thecallingfeaturesthatenhanceyourPCSService. This section
outlines your basic PCS Service features.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
175
Using Voicemail
Setting Up YourVoicemail
All unanswered calls to your PCS Vision Phone are automatically
transferred to your voicemail, even if your phone is in use or turned
off. Therefore, you will want to set up your PCS Voicemail and
personal greeting as soon as your PCS Vision Phone is activated.
Tosetupyourvoicemail:
1. Press and hold
.
2. Follow the system prompts to:
Ⅲ
Create your passcode
Ⅲ
Record your greeting
Ⅲ
Record your name announcement
Ⅲ
Choose whether or not to activate One-Touch Message
Access (a feature that lets you access messages and
bypassing the need for you to enter your passcode)
Note: The voicemail setup process may vary in certain Affiliate areas.
Voicemail Notification
There are several ways your PCS Vision Phone alerts you of a
new message:
ⅷ
By displaying a message on the screen.
ⅷ
By sounding the assigned ringer type.
ⅷ
By the LED blinking red.
ⅷ
By displaying
at the top of your screen.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
176
NewVoicemail MessageAlerts
When you receive a new voice message, your phone alerts you and
prompts you to call your voicemail.
Tocallyourvoicemail:
ᮣ
Press
.
TodisplayyourMissedLog:
ᮣ
Press
or OK (left softkey).
Important: When you are roaming off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network, you
may not receive notification of new voicemail messages. It is recommended that
you periodically check your voicemail by dialing 1 + area code + your PCS Phone
Number. When your voicemail answers, press
and enter your passcode.
You will be charged roaming rates when accessing voicemail while roaming off
the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
Note: Your phone accepts messages even when it is turned off. However, you are
only notified of new messages when your phone is turned on and you are in a
PCS Service Area.
RetrievingYourVoicemail Messages
You can review your messages directly from your PCS Vision Phone or
from any other touch-tone phone. To dial from your PCS Vision Phone,
you can either speed dial your voicemail or use the menu keys.
UsingOne-TouchMessageAccess
ᮣ
Press and hold
. (Your phone will dial your voicemail box.)
UsingtheMenuKeysonYourPhonetoAccessYourMessages
1. Press to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select Voicemail and press
.
4. Select CallVoicemail and press
.
Note: You are charged for airtime minutes when you are accessing your
voicemail from your PCS Vision Phone.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
177
UsingaPhoneOtherThanYourPCSVisionPhoneto
AccessMessages
1. Dial your PCS Phone number.
2. When your voicemail answers, press
.
3. Enter your passcode.
Tip: When you call into voicemail you first hear the header information (date,
time, and sender information) for the message. To skip directly to the message,
press
during the header.
VoicemailButtonGuide
Here’s a quick guide to your keypad functions while listening to
voicemail messages. For further details and menu options, see
“Voicemail Menu Key” on page 182.
Date/Time Send Reply Advance
Replay
Erase
Rewind
Call Back
Help
Forward
Save
Cancel
Skip
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
178
Voicemail Options
Your PCS Vision Phone offers several options for organizing and
accessing your voicemail.
UsingExpertMode
Using the Expert Mode setting for your personal voicemail box helps
you navigate through the voicemail system more quickly by
shortening the voice prompts you hear at each level.
ToturnExpertModeonoroff:
1. Press and hold
to access your voicemail. (If your voicemail
box contains any new or saved messages, press
to access
the main voicemail menu.)
2. Press
to change your Personal Options, following the
system prompts.
3. Press
for Expert Mode.
4. Press
to turn Expert Mode on or off.
SettingUpGroupDistributionLists
Create up to 20 separate group lists, each with up to 20 customers.
1. Press and hold
to access your voicemail. (If your voicemail
box contains any new or saved messages, press
the main voicemail menu.)
to access
2. Press
to change your Personal Options, following the
system prompts.
3. Press
for Administrative Options.
for Group Distribution Lists.
4. Press
5. Follow the voice prompts to create, edit, rename, or delete
group lists.
PCSCallback
Return a call after listening to a message without disconnecting
from voicemail.
ᮣ
Press
after listening to a message. (Once the call is
complete, you’re returned to the voicemail main menu.)
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
179
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessage
Record and send a voice message to other PCS Voicemail users.
1. From the main voicemail menu, press
to send a message.
2. Follow the voice prompts to enter the phone number.
3. Follow the voice prompts to record and send your voice
message.
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessageReply
Reply to a voice message received from any other PCS Voicemail user.
1. After listening to a voice message, press
.
2. Follow the voice prompts to record and send your reply.
Voicemail-to-VoicemailMessageForwarding
Forward a voice message, except those marked “Private,” to other
PCS Voicemail users.
1. After listening to a message, press
.
2. Follow the voice prompts to enter the phone number.
3. Follow the voice prompts to record your introduction and
forward the voice message.
Voicemail-to-VoicemailReceiptRequest
Receive confirmation that your voice message has been listened to
when you send, forward, or reply to other PCS users.
1. After you have recorded a message, press
to indicate you
are satisfied with the message you recorded.
2. Press
to mark receipt requested.
3. Press
to send your voicemail message.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
180
ContinueRecording
When leaving a voice message, you can choose to continue recording
even after you’ve stopped.
ᮣ
Before pressing
to indicate that you are satisfied with the
message you recorded, press
to continue recording.
ExtendedAbsenceGreeting
When your phone is turned off or you are off the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network for an extended period, this greeting can be played
instead of your normal personal greeting.
1. From the main voicemail menu, press
for Personal
Options.
2. Press
for Greetings.
to record an Extended Absence Greeting.
3. Press
Clearing the Message Icon
Your phone may temporarily continue to display the message icon
after you have checked your voice and text messages.
Tocleartheiconfromthedisplayscreen:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
3. Select Voicemail and press
4. Select ClearCount and press
.
.
.
5. Select Yes and press
.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
181
Voicemail Menu Key
Following the prompts on the voicemail system, you can use your
keypad to navigate through the voicemail menu. The following list
outlines your phone’s voicemail menu structure.
Listen
Envelope Information
Reply
Advance 8 Seconds
Replay
Rewind
Forward Message
Erase
Callback
Save
Options
Send a Message
Personal Options
Notification Options
Phone Notification
Numeric Paging to a PCS Phone
Return to Personal Options Menu
Administrative Options
Skip Pass code
Autoplay
Message Date & Time On/Off
Change Pass code
Group Distribution List
Return to Personal Options Menu
Greetings
Personal Greetings
Name Announcement
Extended Absence Greeting
Return to Personal Options Menu
Expert Mode (On/Off)
Place a Call
Disconnect
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
182
Using Caller ID
Caller ID allows people to identify a caller before answering the
phone by displaying the number of the incoming call. If you do not
want your number displayed when you place a call, just follow these
easy steps.
Toblockyourphonenumberfrombeingdisplayedforaspecific
outgoingcall:
1. Press
2. Enter the number you want to call.
3. Press
.
.
To permanently block your number, call PCS Customer Solutions.
Responding to CallWaiting
When you’re on a call, Call Waiting alerts you of incoming calls by
sounding two beeps. Your phone’s screen informs you that another
call is coming in and displays the caller’s phone number (if it is
available and you are in digital mode).
Torespondtoanincomingcallwhileyou’reonacall:
ᮣ
Press
(or press Options [right softkey], highlight Flash, and
press ). (This puts the first caller on hold and answers the
second call.)
Toswitchbacktothefirstcaller:
ᮣ
Press
again (or press Options [right softkey], highlight
Flash, and press ).
Tip: For those calls where you don’t want to be interrupted, you can temporarily
disable Call Waiting by pressing
before placing your call.
Call Waiting is automatically reactivated once you end the call.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
183
Making a Three-Way Call
With Three-Way Calling, you can talk to two people at the same time.
When using this feature, the normal airtime rates will be charged for
each of the two calls.
TomakeaThree-WayCall:
1. Enter a number you wish to call and press
or
.
2. Once you have established the connection, press
(or press
Options [right softkey], highlight Three-WayCall, and press ).
(This puts the first caller on hold.)
3. Dial the second number you wish to call and press
(or
press Options [right softkey], highlight Call or Call:SpeakerOn,
and press ).
4. When you’re connected to the second party, press
again
(or press Options [right softkey], highlight Flash, and press
)
to begin your three-way call.
If one of the people you called hangs up during your call, you and the
remaining caller stay connected. If you initiated the call and are the
first to hang up, all three callers are disconnected.
Tip: You can also begin a Three-Way Call by displaying a phone number stored in
your Contacts, Call History, or Messaging. To call the third party, press
step 3 above.
during
Note: Call Waiting and Three-Way Calling are not available while roaming off the
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
184
Using Call Forwarding
Call Forwarding lets you forward all your incoming calls to another
phone number – even when your phone is turned off. You can
continue to make calls from your phone when Call Forwarding is
activated.
ToactivateCallForwarding:
1. Press
.
2. Enter the area code and phone number to which your future
calls should be forwarded.
3. Press
. (You will hear a tone to confirm the activation of
Call Forwarding.)
TodeactivateCallForwarding:
1. Press
.
2. Press
. (You will hear a tone to confirm the deactivation.)
Note: You are charged a higher rate for calls you have forwarded.
Note: PCS Ready Link calls cannot be forwarded. If Call Forwarding is activated,
incoming PCS Ready Link calls will not be completed.
Section 3A: PCS Service Features – The Basics
185
Section 3B
SM
PCS Vision
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ GettingStartedWithPCSVision
UnderstandingMessaging
UsingEmail
ࡗ AccessingGames ࡗ AccessingRingers ࡗ AccessingScreenSavers AccessingAlternateEmailProviders
ࡗ ExploringtheWeb UsingInstantMessaging
ࡗ UsingPCSBusinessConnection ExperiencingWirelessOnlineChat
ࡗ PCSVisionFAQs DownloadingPremiumServicesContent
SM
PCS Vision bringsyouclarityyoucanseeandhearwithadvanced
multimediaservices. These features, including PCS Messaging,
games, downloadable ringers and screen savers, Web access, and
SM
PCS Business Connection are easy to learn and use. The rich,
colorful graphic experience is visually comparable to your home or
office computer. Clearly, it’s a whole new way to look at wireless.
This section introduces these advanced services and walks you
through the necessary steps to start taking advantage of PCS Vision.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
186
Getting StartedWith PCSVision
With your PCS Vision Phone and PCS Service, you are ready to start
enjoying the advantages of PCS Vision. This section will help you
learn the basics of using your PCS Vision services, including
managing your User Name, launching a Vision connection, and
navigating the Web with your PCS Vision Phone.
Your User Name
When you buy a PCS Vision Phone and sign up for service, you’re
automatically assigned a User Name. A User Name is typically based
on your name and a number, followed by “@sprintpcs.com.” For
example, the third John Smith to sign up for PCS Vision services
name you want – as long as nobody else has it.
When you use PCS Vision services, your User Name is submitted to
identify you to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. The User Name
is also useful as an address for Email, as a way to personalize Web
services, and as an online virtual identity.
Your User Name will be automatically programmed into your
PCS Vision Phone. You don’t have to enter it.
UpdatingYourUserName
When you change the programmed User Name and select a new one,
you have to update your User Name through your PCS Phone.
ToupdateyourUserName:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
.
3. Select PCSVision and press
.
4. Select UpdateProfile and press
.
Ⅲ
If you want to cancel, press
while processing.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
187
FindingYourUserName
If you aren’t sure what your PCS Vision User Name is, you can easily
find it online or on your PCS Vision Phone.
TofindyourUserName:
ⅷ
PCS Phone Number and password. To view your PCS Vision User
Name, click on the MyPersonalInformation menu and then click
PCSVisionUserName.
ⅷ
OnyourPCSVisionPhone. To find your User Name, access your
phone’s main menu, go to Settings > PhoneInfo > Phone#/UserID.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
188
Launching a PCSVision Connection
TolaunchaPCSVisionconnection:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Web and press . (Your PCS Vision connection will
launch and the PCS Vision Home page will display.)
The PCS Vision Home Page
Vision Home
Personalize with
Downloads
1. Messaging
2. Downloads
3. News
4. Weather
5. Sports
6. Entertainment
Go
Shortcut: You can also press Web (right softkey) in standby mode.
Note: If Net Guard is enabled and displayed (see the next page), press OK (left
softkey) to continue and launch the Web.
Tip: When Ready Link Guard is set to On, a warning message will appear.
Press Continue (left softkey) to continue. (See page 149 for Ready Link Guard.)
While connecting, the following will appear on the screen:
Connecting...Pleasewait..
If you had a previous PCS Vision connection, the last page you visited
(for example, Email or ESPN Top News) will display when you launch
your browser. When this occurs, you may not see the “Connecting...”
message when you launch the session. Though the browser is open,
you are not currently in an active data session - that is, no data is being
sent or received. As soon as you navigate to another page, the active
session will launch and you will see the “Connecting...” message.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
189
Net Guard
When you first connect to the Web, the Net Guard will appear to
confirm that you want to connect. This feature helps you avoid
accidental connections. You can disable the Net Guard in the future
by selecting AlwaysAuto-Connect when the Net Guard is displayed.
TochangeyourNetGuardsettings:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Settings and press
3. Select PCSVision and press
4. Select NetGuard and press
.
.
.
5. Select On or Off and press
.
Ⅲ
On to activate the Net Guard.
Ⅲ
Off to deactivate the Net Guard.
Note: When enabled, the Net Guard appears only once per session. The Net
Guard does not appear if the phone is merely re-connecting due to a time-out.
PCSVision Connection Status and Indicators
Your phone’s display lets you know the current status of your
PCS Vision connection through indicators which appear at the top
of the screen. The following symbols are used:
Your PCS Vision connection is active (data is being transferred);
the transmit/receive symbol will blink to indicate data
transmission. Incoming voice calls go directly to voicemail;
outgoing voice calls can be made, but the PCS Vision
connection will terminate.
Your PCS Vision connection is dormant (no data is being sent
or received). Though not currently active, when dormant the
phone can restart an active connection quickly; voice calls can
be made and received.
Your phone is not currently able to access PCS Vision service
features.
If no indicator appears, your phone does not have a current
PCS Vision connection. To launch a connection, see “Launching a
PCS Vision Connection” on the previous page.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
190
Navigating the Web
Navigating through menus and Websites during a PCS Vision
session is easy once you’ve learned a few basics. Here are some tips
for getting around:
Softkeys
During a PCS Vision session, the bottom line of your phone’s display
contains one or more softkeys. These keys are shortcut controls for
navigating around the Web, and they correspond to the softkey
buttons directly below the phone’s display screen.
Tip: Depending on which Websites you visit, the labels on the softkeys may
change to indicate their function.
Tousesoftkeys:
ᮣ
Press the desired softkey button. (If an additional pop-up menu
appears when you press the softkey button, select the menu
items using your keypad [if they’re numbered] or by
highlighting the option and pressing .)
1. Messaging
2. Downloads
3. News
4. Weather
5. Sports
6. Entertainment
7. Money
8. Find if...
9. Portals
10. My Account
left softkey
Scrolling
Go
right softkey
As with other parts of your phone’s menu, you’ll have to scroll up and
down to see everything on some Websites.
ToscrolllinebylinethroughWebsites:
ᮣ
Press the navigation key up or down.
ToscrollpagebypagethroughWebsites:
ᮣ
Press the volume buttons on the side of the phone.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
191
Selecting
Once you’ve learned how to use softkeys and scroll, you can start
navigating the Web.
Toselecton-screenitems:
ᮣ
Use the navigation key to highlight the desired item, then press
the desired softkey button (or press
).
Tip: You’ll find that the left softkey is used primarily for selecting items. This
softkey is often labeled “Go.”
Tip: If the items on a page are numbered, you can use your keypad (number keys)
to select an item. (The tenth item in a numbered list may be selected by pressing
the
key on your phone’s keypad, even though the number 0 doesn’t appear
on the screen.)
Links allow you to jump to different Web pages, select special
functions, or even place phone calls.
Toselectlinks:
ᮣ
Highlight the link and select the appropriate softkey.
GoingBack
Togobackonepage:
ᮣ
Press the
key on your phone.
Note: The keyisalsousedfordeletingtext(likeaBACKSPACEkey)whenyou
are entering text.
GoingHome
ToreturntothePCSVisionHomepagefromanyotherWebpage:
ᮣ
Press the right softkey, then highlight Home and press
OK (left softkey).
Tip: You can also return to the PCS Vision Home page by pressing and holding
the
key.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
192
PCS Messaging
Understanding Messaging
Now you can send and receive emails and text messages and
participate in Web-based chatrooms right from your PCS Vision
Phone. Messaging allows you to stay connected to friends, family,
and co-workers 24 hours a day anywhere on the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network.
Note: In some instances, when you receive a text message, characters with
accents will be displayed as question marks.
MessageTypes
There are many types of text messaging available on your phone.
These appear on your screen as Notifications and include numeric
messages (pages), Messages, Updates, and Mail.
(PCS Voicemail provides voicemail-to-mailbox messaging.
For information on using your phone’s voicemail feature, see
“Using Voicemail” on page 176.)
New Messages
When you receive a new Message, your phone will alert you.
Press View (left softkey) to display the message details.
ⅷ
Press Call (left softkey) to dial the phone number. (Appears when
a phone number is highlighted.)
ⅷ
Press Reply (left softkey) to reply to the message. (Appears when
a phone number or email address is highlighted.)
ⅷ
Press Go (left softkey) to go to the Website. (Appears when a URL
is highlighted.)
ⅷ
Press Forward (left softkey) to forward the message. (Appears
only if there are no phone numbers or URLs in the message.)
ⅷ
Press Options (right softkey) to display options. (See page 197 for
details.)
Tip: When you highlight a phone number, the left softkey may display Call or
Reply depending on the circumstance.
Tip: To make a Ready Link call from the message, press and hold
applicable).
(if
Section 3B: PCS Vision
193
Message Storage
Your PCS Phone can store up to 200 received and 180 sent Messages.
When the message memory is full, the oldest unlocked message will
be deleted automatically. (See page 198 for locking messages.)
Displaying Messages
To display a Message from the message notification alert, see “New
Messages” on the previous page.
TodisplayaMessagefromthemainmenu:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select TextMsg and press . (The folder list appears.)
4. Select Inbox, Sent, Outbox, Drafts, or your defined folder and
press . (The message list appears.)
5. Highlight the header of the message you want to see and
press . (The message detail appears.)
If the sender’s or addressee’s information has already been stored in
the Contacts list, the corresponding name or phone number appears
as the header of the message.
Toreadothermessages:
ᮣ
Press the navigation key left to read the previous message.
ᮣ
Press the navigation key right to read the next message.
Displaying Picture Mail
When you receive a Picture Mail, your phone will save it into the
Picture Mail Inbox automatically.
TodisplayaPicturefromthemainmenu:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select PictureMail and press
.
4. Select Inbox and press
.
5. Select your desired message and press
.
6. Highlight the URL in the message and press Go (left softkey).
(The browser will launch and display the picture.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
194
Sending a Message
With Messaging, you can use a person’s wireless phone number to
send and receive text messages from your PCS Vision Phone to their
messaging-ready phone – and they can send messages to you. When
you receive a new message, you’ll automatically be notified with a
two-way text message.
Tosendatextmessage:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
3. Select SendMessage and press
4. Select TextMessage and press
.
.
.
5. Select FromPhoneBook, MobilePhone#, or EmailAddress and
press
to enter recipients.
Ⅲ
FromPhoneBook to select a recipient from your Contacts list.
Highlight an entry and press to select. Or select
<AddEntry> to enter a new entry. Press Done (left softkey)
when you are finished selecting/entering recipients.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
MobilePhone# to enter a mobile phone number directly.
EmailAddress to enter an email address directly.
6. To add a recipient, press Options (right softkey), select
AddRecipients, and press
.
Ⅲ
Edit to edit the selected entry.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Erase to erase the selected entry.
EraseAll to erase all entries you have selected/entered.
AddRecipient to add recipients.
7. Press Next (left softkey) when you are finished selecting/entering
recipients (you may include up to 10 recipients).
8. To enter a message, select the box under Message and press
.
9. Use your keypad to enter a text message (or press Mode [right
softkey] to select from PresetMessages or RecentMessages),
and press OK (left softkey).
10. To set the message priority, select the box under Priority and
press
11. Select Ordinary or Urgent and press
Tip: If you select Urgent, the message will be sent with
12. Press Send (left softkey) to send the message.
.
.
.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
195
To change the recipients or to save the message as a draft, press
Options (right softkey) and select an option from the following during
steps 7-11 on the previous page.
ⅷ
ChgRecipients to change Recipients.
ⅷ
SendCallback# to select from None, MyPhone#, or Other to notify
your recipients of your callback number. (See “Setting a Callback
Number” on page 62.)
ⅷ
SavetoDrafts to save the message to a Drafts folder. (See below to
edit and send the draft message.)
Note: If there is a failure when sending a message in no-service area, you are
prompted to select to send the message automatically. Press Yes (left softkey),
and the message goes to the Outbox folder with . If you press No (right softkey),
the message goes to the folder with . (See next page to send the message.)
Sending a Message in the Drafts Folder
Toeditandsendamessageinthedraftsfolder:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select TextMsg and press
.
4. Select Drafts and press
.
5. Select the message you wish to edit and press Edit (left softkey).
6. After editing the message, press Send (left softkey) to send the
message.
Tip: The oldest message in the drafts folder will be erased when you save more
than 10 messages.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
196
Sending a Message in the Outbox Folder
If a failure occurs when you try to send a message, the message goes
to the Outbox folder.
TosendamessagefromtheOutboxfolder:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select TextMsg and press
.
4. Select Outbox and press
.
5. Select the message you wish to send and press Send (left softkey).
Message Options
Several options are available when you display a folder list, message
list, or message details.
FolderListOptions
Select Inbox, Sent, Outbox, Drafts, or your defined folder and press
Options (right softkey). To select an option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
EditFolder to edit the folder (user-defined folder only).
ⅷ
EraseFolder to erase the folder (user-defined folder only).
ⅷ
CreateFolder to create a new user-defined folder.
ⅷ
ComposeNew to compose a new message.
ⅷ
EraseMessages to erase messages (if applicable).
MessageListOptions
To display a message list, select Inbox (or defined folder), Sent, Outbox,
or Drafts and press . To display your Picture Mail message list,
select PictureMail from the Messaging menu, press , select Inbox,
and press . Then highlight a message and press Options (right
softkey) to display options.
ⅷ
Reply to reply to the message. (See page 195 to send a message.)
(Inbox only.)
ⅷ
Forward to forward the message. Select from FromPhoneBook,
MobilePhone#, or EmailAddress. (Inbox and Sent only.)
ⅷ
Edit to edit a message. (Outbox and Drafts only.)
ⅷ
Send to send a message. (Outbox and Drafts only.)
ⅷ
Move to move a message to the Inbox or to your defined folder.
Select a folder and press , or press <AddFolder> to create a new
folder. (See page 200 to create a folder.) (Inbox only.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
197
ⅷ
ⅷ
Lock to lock a message. Locked messages will not be erased
automatically. To unlock the message, select Unlock and press
(Picture Mail Inbox, Inbox, and Sent only.)
.
ComposeNew to compose a new message. (See page 195 to
compose a new message.)
ⅷ
ⅷ
Erase to erase the selected message.
EraseReadMsgs to erase read messages in the folder (except
locked messages). (Picture Mail Inbox, Inbox only.)
ⅷ
EraseAll toeraseallmessagesinthefolder(exceptlockedmessages).
A warning message appears if there are unread messages.
Tip: Locked messages will be displayed with
.
Tip: To make a call from the list, highlight a message and press
applicable).
or
(if
MessageDetailsOptions
After you display the Message list in the Picture Mail Inbox, Inbox,
Sent, or your defined folder, press to display the message details.
Press Options (right softkey) to display message options. To select an
option, highlight it and press
.
ⅷ
Call(GotoList) to call a number in the message. Select a number
and press or Call (left softkey) to place a call. Press and hold
to make a Ready Link call.
Call:SpeakerOn to call in speaker mode. Select a number and
ⅷ
or Call (left softkey) to place a call. Press and hold
to make a
Ready Link call.
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
ⅷ
Prepend to add numbers to the beginning of the phone number (if
applicable).
GotoURLList to display URLs in the message. Press Go (left
softkey) or select a URL and press
to go to the site.
SendMessage to display phone numbers and email addresses to
send a message. (See page 195 for details.) (Except Picture Mail)
Reply to reply to the message. (See page 195 to send a message.)
(Message in Inbox and defined folder only.)
Forward to forward the message. Select from FromPhoneBook,
MobilePhone#, or EmailAddress. (Except Picture Mail)
Move to move the message to another folder. Select a folder and
press
or press <AddFolder> to create a new folder.
(See page 200 to create a folder.) (Message in Inbox and defined
folder only.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
198
ⅷ
Lock to lock the message. Locked messages will not be erased
automatically. To unlock the message, select Unlock and press
FontSize to change the font size from Small or Normal.
SavetoPh. Book to save the phone number, email address, and
.
ⅷ
ⅷ
URLs. Select a data category and press
to save.
ⅷ
ⅷ
GotoPhoneBook to go to the Contacts list (if applicable).
ComposeNew to compose a new message. (See page 195 to
compose a message.)
ⅷ
Erase to erase the message.
Changing the Display Font Size of a Message
After you display a Message (except in the Outbox and Drafts folder),
press Options (right softkey) to display message options.
Toadjustthedisplayfontsize:
1. Select FontSize and press
.
2. Select Small or Normal and press
.
Prepending a Phone Number From a Message
After you display a Message (except in the Outbox and Drafts folder),
press Options (right softkey) to display message options.
Toaddaprefixtoaphonenumber:
1. Select Prepend and press
.
2. Highlight your desired phone number and press
or OK (left
softkey).
3. Enter the digits or pauses (see below) you want to add to the
number.
4. Press
or
to make a call.
To select another option, press Options (right softkey), highlight it
and press
.
Ⅲ
Call to dial the phone number.
Ⅲ
Call:SpeakerOn to dial the phone number in speakerphone
mode.
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
Ⅲ
SavePhone# to store the phone number in your Contacts
Directory.
H HardPause to insert a hard pause. (See “Dialing and
Saving Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 28.)
T 2-Sec. Pause to insert a 2-second pause. (See “Dialing and
Saving Phone Numbers With Pauses” on page 28.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
199
Message Folders
Incoming Updates and numeric pages are stored in folders in your
phone’s Messaging menu. You may add your own folders or use the
phone’s default folder.
You can create up to ten folders to store your Messages. When ten
user-defined folders exist, the “Create Folder ”option will not appear.
Toaddanewfolder:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select TextMsg and press
.
4. Press Options (right softkey).
5. Select CreateFolder and press
.
6. Enter a folder name and press
or OK (left softkey).
Ⅲ
Pressing Save (left softkey) allows you to save the folder
name.
7. If you want messages to be filed into the folder automatically,
select the menu under AutoFiling and press
8. Select On and press
9. Select the box under Keyword by scrolling down and press
.
.
.
10. Enter a keyword and press
or OK (left softkey).
11. Press Save (left softkey).
Tosetanoptionalfeaturefortheaddedfolder:
1. During step 9 above, scroll down to select other menu options.
Highlight the menu under each item and press
.
Ⅲ
Notify to set the display notification to on or off when you
have unread messages matching the defined folder.
Ⅲ
EnvelopeIcon to set the envelope icon display to on or off
when you have unread messages matching the defined folder.
2. After selecting each setting, press Save (left softkey).
Section 3B: PCS Vision
200
Toeditafolder:
1. From the folder list display, highlight a defined folder.
2. Press Options (right softkey).
3. Select EditFolder and press
.
4. Select the box you wish to edit and press
.
5. Enter or select a new folder name/setting.
6. Press
or OK (left softkey).
7. Press Save (left softkey).
ErasingAll Messages
Toeraseallmessageswithinafolder:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select TextMsg and press
.
4. Select Inbox, Sent, Outbox, Drafts, or your defined folder and
press
.
5. Press Options (right softkey).
6. Select EraseAll and press . (A confirmation will display.)
7. Select Yes and press
.
Moving a Message IntoAnother Folder
You can move messages from the Inbox folder to a user-defined folder.
Tomoveamessageintoanotherfolder:
1. After you display a message in your Inbox folder, press Options
(right softkey) to display the message options.
2. Highlight Move and press
.
3. Highlight your desired folder and press . (You must have at
least one defined folder to move a message.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
201
Erasing a Folder
Toeraseatextmessagefolder:
1. From the folder list display, highlight the defined folder you
want to erase.
2. Press Options (right softkey).
3. Highlight EraseFolder and press
4. Select Yes and press
.
.
Note: When you erase a folder, the messages within the folder are also erased.
If the folder contains a new (unread) message or locked message, you are
prompted to select Erase or Don’t Erase.
Erasing Selected Messages inAll Folders
Toeraseselectedmessages:
1. From the folder list display, press Options (right softkey).
2. Select EraseMessages and press
.
3. Select Read, Unread, and/or Sent and press
to check the
appropriate box(es).
4. After selecting the boxes, press Done (left softkey).
5. Select Erase and press
to erase selected messages (except
locked messages).
Note: To erase an individual message, see “Message List Options” on page 197.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
202
Signing Up for Updates
With Updates, you can have news and information sent directly to
your PCS Vision Phone at the times you choose.
ToselecttheinformationyouwanttosendtoyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. Log on to the Internet from your computer.
2. Go to the site from which you want to receive information.
®
®
(A few of the sites you can visit are America Online , Yahoo! ,
®,
®
MSN and eBay . The location where you request updates
within each site will vary.)
3. Where indicated on the site, input your 10-digit PCS Phone
number followed by “@messaging.sprintpcs.com.” (For
Upon completing the registration process, you should begin
receiving updates on your PCS Vision Phone as requested.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
203
Using Email
With Email, you can set up an account at no additional charge and
perform many of the typical email functions from your PCS Vision
Phone that you can from your personal computer.
You can manage your Email account from your PCS Vision Phone or
access other select email providers from the Web through your Email.
Accessing Email Messages
ToaccessEmailmessages:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Messaging and press
.
3. Select GotoEmail and press . (If you’re a first-time user, your
phone will prompt you to set up your Email account by
establishing a User Name and password.)
4. To view your messages, press Inbox (left softkey).
5. Scroll to select the message you wish to read and press the left
softkey.
6. Once you’ve read a message, use the quick actions at the end of
each message (Reply, ReplyAll, Forward, Erase, AddtoFolder,
or Main).
Composing Email Messages
TocomposeanEmailmessage:
1. From the Email menu (see steps 1-3 above), press Compose (left
softkey).
2. Scroll to select the address box and enter the address of the
person to whom you ’re sending a message and press the left
softkey.
3. Scroll to select the message box and enter the subject and your
message.
4. Select Send when your message is ready to be delivered.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
204
AccessingAlternate Email Providers
With PCS Vision, you can use popular email services such as
®
®
®
AOL Mail, Yahoo! Mail, MSN Hotmail, and EarthLink to keep in
touch even while you’re on the go.
UsingAlternate Email Providers
ToaccessemailprovidersfromyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. From the PCS Vision Home page, select Messaging.
2. Select Email.
3. Select an email provider, such as AOLMail, Yahoo!Mail, or
EarthLink.
4. Use your keypad to enter the required sign in information for
the selected provider, such as user name, email address, and/or
password, and select SignIn. (Your mailbox for the selected
provider will display.)
Note: The information required for sign in will vary depending on the email
provider you are accessing.
5. Follow the onscreen instructions to read, reply to, compose,
send, and manage your email account.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
205
Using Instant Messaging
PCS Vision also provides you with access to popular instant
®
messaging (IM) clients, including Yahoo! Messenger, and
®
TM
AOL Instant Messenger .
Accessing Instant Messaging
ToaccessinstantmessagingclientsfromyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. From the PCS Vision Home page, select Messaging.
2. SelectInstantMessaging.
3. Select an email provider, such as AOLInstantMessenger or
Yahoo!Messenger.
4. Use your keypad to enter the required sign in information for
the selected provider, such as user name and/or password, and
select SignIn. (Your IM screen for the selected provider will
display.)
Note: The information required for sign in will vary depending on the instant
messaging provider you are accessing.
5. Follow the onscreen instructions to read, reply to, compose,
send, and manage your IM account.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
206
ExperiencingWireless Online Chat
PCS Vision gives you the ability to join wireless chatrooms from
your PCS Vision Phone, to send text messages and icons to chatroom
participants, or to launch a one-on-one (private) chatroom.
Toaccessachatroomfromthebrowser:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Highlight Web and press
3. Select Messaging.
4. Select Chat.
.
5. Select Enter. (You will see a disclaimer for Wireless Chat.)
6. SelectIAgreeto enter the Chat menu.
7. Select a chatroom from the menu (for example, “Friends”
or “Singles”).
8. Use your keypad to enter a nickname and select Enter. (Once in
the chatroom, you may scroll through the postings to read
messages from other chatroom participants.)
Topostamessage:
1. During an active chatroom session, select Addtext.
2. Enter your message.
3. Select Send.
Tosetupaprivatechatroom:
1. During an active chatroom session, select 1->1.
2. Select a chatter with whom you’d like to launch a private
chatroom.
Toexitachatroom:
ᮣ
Select LeaveRoom.
Note: To avoid inadvertent data usage charges, you should sign out of
chatrooms when you are ready to exit.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
207
Downloading Premium Services Content
With PCS Vision and your new PCS Vision Phone, you have access to a
dynamic variety of Premium Service content such as downloadable
Games, Ringers, Screen Savers, and other applications. The basic
steps required to access and download Premium Service content are
outlined below.
AccessingtheDownloadMenus
ToaccessthePCSVisiondownloadmenus:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Select the type of file you wish to download (Games, Ringers,
ScreenSavers, or Applications) and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
4. Select GetNew and press . (The browser will launch and take
you to the corresponding download menu.)
ToaccessthePCSVisiondownloadmenusfromtheWebbrowser:
ᮣ
From the PCS Vision Home page, select Games, Ringers, or
ScreenSavers to go to the corresponding download menu.
(For more information on navigating the Web, see “Navigating
the Web” on page 191.)
SelectinganItemtoDownload
You can search for available items to download in a number of ways:
ⅷ
Featured displays a rotating selection of featured items.
ⅷ
BrowseCategory allows you to narrow your search to a general
category, such as Movie/TV Themes for Ringers or College Logos
for Screen Savers. (There may be several pages of available
content in a list. Select Next9 to view additional items.)
ⅷ
Search allows you to use your keypad to enter search criteria to
locate an item. You may enter an entire word or title or perform a
partial-word search (for example, entering “goo” returns “Good
Ol’ Boy,” “The Good, the Bad, and the Ugly,” and “Goofy - Club”).
Section 3B: PCS Vision
208
DownloadinganItem
Once you’ve selected an item you wish to download, highlight it and
press
or OK (left softkey). You will see a summary page for the
item including its title, the vendor, the download detail, the file size,
and the cost. Links allow you to view the LicenseDetails page, which
outlines the price, license type, and length of license for the
download, and the TermsofUse page, which details the Premium
Services Terms of Use and your responsibility for payment.
Todownloadaselecteditem:
1. From the information page, select Buy. (The item will download
automatically. When the NewDownload screen appears, the
item has been successfully downloaded to your phone.)
Note: If you have not previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to
create your purchasing profile.
2. Select an option to continue:
Ⅲ
Select Use (left softkey) to assign the downloaded item (or
to launch, in the case of a game or application).
Your PCS Vision session will end and you will be redirected
to the appropriate phone menu screen.
Ⅲ
Select Shop (right softkey) to browse for other items to
download.
Ⅲ
Press
to quit the browser and return to standby mode.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
209
Games
Accessing Games
You can play a variety of entertaining and graphically-rich games on
your PCS Vision Phone. New games are easy to download and play.
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see “Downloading Premium
Services Content” on page 208.
DownloadingGames
Todownloadanavailablegametoyourphone:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Highlight Games and press
.
4. Highlight GetNew and press . (The browser will launch and
take you to the Games download menu.)
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a game you wish
to download. (For more information on navigating the Web, see
“Navigating the Web” on page 191.)
6. Select Buy from the item information page. (The game will
download automatically. When the NewDownload screen
appears, the game has been successfully downloaded to
your phone.)
Note: If you have not previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to
create your purchasing profile.
7. Select an option to continue:
Ⅲ
Select Use (left softkey) to launch the downloaded game.
Your PCS Vision session will end and you will be redirected
to the appropriate phone menu screen.
Ⅲ
Select Shop (right softkey) to browse for other items to
download.
Ⅲ
Press
to quit the browser and return to standby mode.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
210
PlayingGames
ToplayadownloadedgameonyourPCSVisionPhone:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Highlight Games and press
.
4. Select the game you wish to play and press
5. Highlight Run and press
.
.
6. Press OK (left softkey) if a prompt displays the days remaining
on the game license.
7. Follow the onscreen instructions to play the game.
Toquitagame:
1. When you are finished playing, press
. (A prompt will
display: “Resume the Application?”)
2. Select Yes to continue playing.
– or –
Select No to exit.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
211
Ringers
Accessing Ringers
You can personalize your PCS Vision Phone by downloading and
assigning different ringers to numbers in your Contacts list.
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see “Downloading Premium
Services Content” on page 208.
DownloadingRingers
Todownloadanavailableringertoyourphone:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
.
3. Highlight Ringers and press
4. Highlight GetNew and press . (The browser will launch and
take you to the Ringers download menu.)
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a ringer you
wish to download. (For more information on navigating the
Web, see “Navigating the Web” on page 191.)
6. From the item information page, select Buy. (The ringer will
download automatically. When the NewDownload screen
appears, the ringer has been successfully downloaded to
your phone.)
Note: If you have not previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to
create your purchasing profile.
7. Select an option to continue:
Ⅲ
Select Use (left softkey) to assign the downloaded ringer.
Your PCS Vision session will end and you will be redirected
to the appropriate phone menu screen.
Ⅲ
Select Shop (right softkey) to browse for other items to
download.
Ⅲ
Press
to quit the browser and return to standby mode.
Note: You may store total of 1024 KB of downloaded data on your phone.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
212
AssigningDownloadedRingers
You can assign downloaded ringers directly from the Downloads
menu or through your phone’s Settings menu.
ToassignadownloadedringerfromtheDownloadsmenu:
1. Press
to access the main menu.
2. Select Downloads and press
.
3. Highlight Ringers and press
.
4. Highlight a downloaded ringer and press
5. Highlight Assign and press
.
.
6. Highlight VoiceCalls, Voicemail, Messaging, Calendar,
Start-upTone, Power-offTone or PhoneBook and press
The following two items need an extra step:
.
Ⅲ
VoiceCalls requires you to highlight WithCallerID or
NocallerID and press
.
Ⅲ
PhoneBook requires you to highlight the Contacts entry you
want to assign and press
.
(A message appears confirming that the ringer has been assigned.)
ToassignadownloadedringerfromtheSettingsmenu:
ᮣ
See “Selecting Ringer Types for Voice Calls” on page 36;
see “Selecting Ringer Types for Voicemail” on page 38;
see “Selecting Ringer Types for Messages” on page 39;
see “Selecting Ringer Types for Calendar” on page 39;
see “Setting a Start-up/Power-off Tone” on page 40;
– or –
see “Selecting a Ringer/Image Type for an Entry” on page 95.
Note: You may assign a ringer to more than one type of call.
PurchasingRingers
You can purchase ringers directly from your phone by following the
Section 3B: PCS Vision
213
Screen Savers
Accessing Screen Savers
Download unique images to use as screen savers – or make it easy to
tell who’s calling by assigning specific images to numbers in your
Contacts list.
Tip: For complete instructions on downloading, see “Downloading Premium
Services Content” on page 208.
DownloadingScreenSavers
TodownloadanavailableScreenSavertoyourphone:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Highlight ScreenSavers and press
to access the main menu.
.
.
4. Highlight GetNew and press . (The browser will launch and
take you to the Screen Savers download menu.)
5. Use your navigation key to highlight and select a Screen Saver
you wish to download. (For more information on navigating the
Web, see “Navigating the Web” on page 191.)
6. From the item information page, select Buy. (The screen saver
will download automatically. When the NewDownload screen
appears, the screen saver has been successfully downloaded to
your phone.)
Note: If you have not previously purchased an item, you will be prompted to
create your purchasing profile.
7. Select an option to continue:
Ⅲ
Select Use (left softkey) to assign the downloaded screen
saver. Your PCS Vision session will end and you will be
redirected to the appropriate phone menu screen.
Ⅲ
Select Shop (right softkey) to browse for other items to
download.
Ⅲ
Press
to quit the browser and return to standby mode.
Note: You may store total of 1024 KB of downloaded data on your phone.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
214
AssigningDownloadedScreenSavers
Downloaded Screen Savers may be assigned directly from the
Downloads menu or through the Settings menu.
ToassignadownloadedScreenSaverfromtheDownloadsmenu:
1. Press
2. Select Downloads and press
3. Highlight ScreenSavers and press
4. Highlight a downloaded Screen Saver and press
5. Select Assign and press
6. Highlight one of IncomingCalls, ScreenSaver, or PhoneBook and
press
to access the main menu.
.
.
.
.
.
The following item needs an extra step:
Ⅲ
PhoneBook requires you to highlight your desired Contacts
entry and press
.
(A message appears confirming that the image has been assigned.)
Note: Depending on the data, you can select where to assign downloaded images:
Image data can be assigned to Incoming Calls, Screen Saver, or Phone Book.
Animation data can be assigned to Standby, Outgoing Calls, or Service Search.
Note: You may assign a Screen Saver to more than one task.
PurchasingScreenSavers
You can purchase Screen Savers directly from your phone by following
Section 3B: PCS Vision
215
Web
Exploring the Web
With Web access on your PCS Vision Phone, you can browse full-
color graphic versions of your favorite Websites, making it easier than
ever to stay informed while on the go. Follow sports scores and
breaking news and weather and shop on your PCS Vision Phone
anywhere on the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
In addition to the features already covered in this section, the
PCS Vision Home page offers access to these colorful, graphically
rich Web categories. Many sites are available under more than one
menu – choose the one that’s most convenient for you.
ⅷ
News. Get up-to-the-minute news regarding finance, business,
sports, and entertainment at sites like CNNtoGo, Bloomberg,
USA Today, and Forbes.
ⅷ
Weather. Access The Weather Channel to get current weather
conditions and forecasts.
ⅷ
Entertainment. Get the latest buzz on your favorite stars as well as
movie and music reviews at Websites like E! Online, Pocket
TM
BoxOffice , and TastNtalk.
ⅷ
Sports. Enjoy current news, statistics, and sports scores, as well as
updates of events in progress at ESPN.com and other sports sites.
ⅷ
Finance. Use Websites like Bloomberg, Fidelity, and Forbes to get
stock quotes, make trades, and check your bank account online.
ⅷ
Travel. Access flight information and make dining arrangements
from travel Websites like Saber and Fodors.com.
ⅷ
Shopping. Browse or purchase from popular shopping Websites
like Amazon.com or Edmunds.
ⅷ
Tools. Use tools like Switchboard to access yellow pages, white
pages – even reverse phone number look-up or use Google to
search for other Websites or images.
ⅷ
BusinessLinks. Access your PCS Business Connection Personal or
Enterprise Edition along with links to many business-related sites.
ⅷ
MyAccount. Check minutes and PCS Vision usage, view your
current invoice, or make a payment.
ⅷ
Search. Use Google to search keywords, articles, and even images.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
216
Using the Browser Menu
Navigating the Web from your phone using the PCS Vision Home
page is easy once you get the hang of it. For details on how to
navigate the Web, select menu items, and more, see “Navigating the
Web” on page 191.
Although the PCS Vision Home page offers a broad and convenient
array of sites and services for you to browse, not all sites are
represented, and certain functions, such as going directly to specific
Websites, are not available. For these and other functions, you will
need to use the browser menu. The browser menu offers additional
functionality to expand your use of the Web on your PCS Vision Phone.
OpeningtheBrowserMenu
The browser menu may be opened anytime you have an active
PCS Vision session, from any page you are viewing.
Toopenthebrowsermenu:
ᮣ
Press (right softkey) from any page during an active
PCS Vision session. (The browser menu will display.)
(To launch a PCS Vision session, please see “Launching a
PCS Vision Connection” on page 189.)
Options available under the browser menu include:
ⅷ
Home. Returns the browser to the PCS Vision Home page.
ⅷ
Forward. Allows you to go forward to the pages you have visited.
ⅷ
Markthispage. Allows you to create new bookmarks.
ⅷ
ViewBookmarks. Allows you to view and access bookmarked sites.
ⅷ
Search. Launches a Google search.
ⅷ
ShowURL. Displays the URL (Website address) of the site you’re
currently viewing.
ⅷ
GotoURL.... Allows you to navigate directly to a Website by
entering its URL (Website address).
ⅷ
History. Displays the pages you have visited.
ⅷ
Refreshthispage. Reloads the current Web page.
ⅷ
More.... Displays the additional menu options. (Restart Browser,
Send Page, and Preferences.)
Section 3B: PCS Vision
217
CreatingaBookmark
Bookmarks allow you to store the address of your favorite Websites
for easy access at a later time.
Tocreateabookmark:
1. Launch the Web page you want to mark.
2. Press (right softkey) to go to the browser menu.
3. Select Markthispage and press
or OK (left softkey).
Note: Bookmarking a page does not store the page contents, just its address.
Some pages cannot be bookmarked. Whether a particular Web page may be
marked is controlled by its creator.
AccessingaBookmark
Toaccessabookmark:
1. Access the browser menu by pressing (right softkey).
2. Select ViewBookmarks and press OK (left softkey).
3. Highlight the bookmark you’d like to access and press
or
OK (left softkey) to go to the Website.
EditingaBookmark
Toeditabookmark:
1. Launch the Web and press (right softkey) to access the
browser menu.
2. Select ViewBookmarks and press OK (left softkey).
3. Select the bookmark you wish to edit and press (right
softkey).
4. Select EditAddress or EditTitle and press OK (left softkey).
5. Press Edit (right softkey), use your keypad to edit the address or
title, and press OK (left softkey).
6. To save the bookmark, press OK (left softkey).
Section 3B: PCS Vision
218
DeletingaBookmark
Todeleteabookmark:
1. Launch the Web and press (right softkey) to access the
browser menu.
2. Select ViewBookmarks and press OK (left softkey).
3. Highlight the bookmark you wish to erase and press (right
softkey).
4. Select Delete and press OK (left softkey).
5. Press Yes (right softkey).
Tip: To delete all bookmarks, select Delete All during step 3 above.
MovingaBookmark
Tomoveabookmark:
1. Access the ViewBookmarks menu as outlined above in steps 1-2,
and press (right softkey).
2. Select Reorder and press OK (left softkey).
3. Highlight the bookmark you wish to move and press Move (left
softkey).
4. Move the bookmark to a new location by pressing the
navigation key up or down and press Drop (left softkey).
5. When you’re finished, press Finish (right softkey).
GoingtoaSpecificWebsite
TogotoaparticularWebsitebyenteringaURL(Websiteaddress):
1. Launch the Web and press (right softkey) to display the
browser menu.
2. Select GotoURL... and press OK (left softkey).
3. Select Address and press OK (left softkey).
4. Press Edit (right softkey), use your keypad to enter the URL of
the Website you wish to go to, and press OK (left softkey).
5. Press OK (left softkey) to go to the Website.
Note: Not all Websites are viewable on your phone.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
219
ReloadingaWebPage
Toreload(refresh)aWebpage:
1. Launch the Web and press (right softkey) to display the
browser menu.
2. Select Refreshthispage and press OK (left softkey).
RestartingtheWebBrowser
If the Web browser appears to be malfunctioning or stops
responding, you can usually fix the problem by simply restarting
the browser.
TorestarttheWebbrowser:
1. From an active PCS Vision connection, press (right softkey)
to display the browser menu.
2. Select More... and press OK (left softkey).
3. Select RestartBrowser and press OK (left softkey).
SendingaWebPage
This feature allows you to send a URL (Website address) you’re
viewing through SMS text messaging.
TosendaWebpage:
1. From an active PCS Vision connection, press (right softkey)
to display the browser menu.
2. Select More... and press OK (left softkey).
3. Select SendPage and press OK (left softkey).
4. To complete and send a Web Page, follow steps 5-12 in
“Sending a Message” on page 195.
AdjustingtheBrowserSoundVolume
Toadjustthebrowsersoundvolume:
1. From an active PCS Vision connection, press (right softkey)
to display the browser menu.
2. Select More... and press OK (left softkey).
3. Select Preferences and press OK (left softkey).
4. Select SoundVolume and press OK (left softkey).
5. Select your desired volume level by pressing the navigation key
up or down and press
.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
220
SM
PCS Business Connection
Using PCS Business Connection
Personal Edition
SM
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition gives you secure,
®
®
®
real-time access to your Microsoft Outlook or Lotus Notes
company email, calendar, business directory, and personal contacts.
You’ll have the features and functions of your Microsoft Outlook and
Lotus Notes so you can view, create, reply to, and delete email;
schedule appointments; and look up phone numbers in real time,
anywhere on the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition delivers the
following features:
ⅷ
Businessemailaccess. Read, reply to, forward, delete, and
compose your company email.
ⅷ
Companydirectoryandcontacts. Search, view, call, and email
contacts from your company’s directory. Do all this and add/edit
your personal contacts.
ⅷ
Workcalendar. Accept and decline meetings, view daily
summaries and details, and navigate to various dates.
ⅷ
Files/informationonyourPC. Browse folders, download, and
view documents from any device using a PC browser or
Pocket Internet Explorer.
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition requires no hardware
or software installation on your company’s network. Just install the
PCS Business Connection Personal Edition software on your work
PC. This allows data to be securely retrieved in real-time by your
wireless device when connected to the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network. There is a monthly charge for PCS Business
Connection and usage charges will also apply.
When your work PC isn’t on, you can share connections with your co-
workers so that you always have access to your email, calendar, and
contacts. Your data remains secure behind the corporate firewall, and
any changes you make on your wireless device are instantly updated on
your company server without the need to synchronize.
Additional PCS Business Connection solutions are available for your
Section 3B: PCS Vision
221
PCSVision FAQs
HowwillIknowwhenmyphoneisreadyforPCSVisionservice?
When your phone is ready, your User Address will be displayed in the
Phone# UserID menu. Go to Settings > PhoneInfo > Phone#/UserID.
HowdoIsign-inforthefirsttime?
You are automatically signed in to access PCS Vision services when
you turn on your phone.
HowdoIknowwhenmyphoneisconnectedtoPCSVisionservices?
Your phone automatically connects when PCS Vision service is used
or an incoming message arrives. Your phone will also display the
icon. (Connecting takes about 10-12 seconds.)
CanImakecallsandusePCS Visionservicesatthesametime?
You cannot use voice and PCS Vision services simultaneously. If you
receive a call while PCS Vision service is active, the call will be
forwarded to voicemail. You can place an outgoing call anytime, but
it will interrupt any in-progress PCS Vision session.
Whenismydataconnectionactive?
Your connection is active when data is being transferred. Outgoing
calls are allowed; incoming calls go directly to voicemail. When
active, the (Sending) or (Receiving) indicator flashes on your
phone’s display screen.
Whenismydataconnectiondormant?
If no data is received for 10 seconds, the connection goes dormant.
When the connection is dormant, voice calls are allowed. (The
connection may become active again quickly.) If no data is received
for an extended period of time, the connection will terminate.
CanIsignoutofdataservices?
You can sign out without turning off your phone; however, you will
not be able to browse the Web or use other PCS Vision services.
While signed out, you can still place or receive phone calls, check
voicemail, and use other voice services. You may sign in again at any
time. To sign out, go to Settings > PCSVision > DisableVision in your
phone’s menu.
Section 3B: PCS Vision
222
Section 3C
SM
PCS Voice Command
In This Section
SM
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ GettingStartedWithPCSVoiceCommand
CreatingYourOwnAddressBook
MakingaCallWithPCSVoiceCommand
AccessingInformationUsingPCSVoiceCommand
WithSprint, thefirstwirelessprovidertoofferinnovative
PCSVoiceCommandtechnology, reachingyourfriends, family, and
co-workershasneverbeeneasier–especiallywhenyou’reonthego.
You can even listen to Web-based information such as news, stock
quotes, weather, sports, and much more. Your voice does it all
with PCS Voice Command.
This section outlines the PCS Voice Command service.
Section 3C: PCS Voice Command
223
SM
Getting StartedWith PCS Voice Command
With PCS Voice Command:
ⅷ
You can store all your contacts’ phone numbers, so you can
simply say the name of the person you want to call.
ⅷ
There’s no need to punch in a lot of numbers, memorize
voicemail passwords, or try to dial while you’re driving.
ⅷ
You can call anyone in your address book – even if you don’t
remember their phone number.
It’sEasytoGetStarted
ᮣ
Just dial
from your PCS Vision Phone to activate the
service and listen to the brief instructions directly from your
phone. There is a monthly charge for PCS Voice Command.
Note: Beginning Fall 2004, dial
to activate your PCS Voice
Command service. PCS Voice Command calls will still be made using
.
CreatingYour OwnAddress Book
You can program up to 500 names into your personal address book,
with each name having up to five phone numbers. That’s 2,500
phone numbers, and with the advanced technology of PCS Voice
Command, you can have instant access to all of them.
There are four ways to update your address book:
ⅷ
UseVoiceRecordings. Simply dial
and say, “Add name.”
You will then be asked to say the name and number you want to
add to your personal address book. Your address book can store
up to 20 voice recorded names at once.
ⅷ
ⅷ
functional Web-based address book to create and update
your contacts.
UseanExistingAddressBook. Automatically merge address books
SM
from desktop software applications with Sprint Sync Services for
no additional charge. Simply click on the “Click to synchronize”
button within your PCS Voice Command personal address book
ⅷ
CallDirectoryAssistance. If you don’t have a computer or Internet
access handy, you can have PCS Directory Assistance look up
phone numbers for you and automatically add them to your
address book. Just say “Call operator” and we’ll add two names
and numbers to your address book for our standard directory
assistance charge.
Section 3C: PCS Voice Command
224
Making a CallWith PCSVoice Command
ToplaceacallwithPCSVoiceCommand:
1. Press
and create your address book once you’ve
signed up for PCS Voice Command. (You’ll hear a tone followed
by the prompt “Ready.”)
2. After the “Ready” prompt, simply say, in a natural voice,
“Call” and the name of the person or the number you’d
like to call. (For example, you can say, “Call Jane Smith at work,”
“Call John Baker on the mobile phone,” “Call 555-1234,” or
“Call Bob Miller.”)
3. Your request will be repeated and you will be asked to verify.
Say “Yes” to call the number or person. (The number will
automatically be dialed.) Say “No” if you wish to cancel.
Tip: Keep in mind that PCS Voice Command recognizes not only your voice,
but any voice, so that others can experience the same convenience if they use
your phone.
For more helpful hints on PCS Voice Command, including a list
of recognized commands and an interactive tutorial, visit
Accessing Information Using
PCSVoice Command
ToaccessinformationusingPCSVoiceCommand:
1. Press
.
2. Say “Call the Web.” (To access, listen to and respond to email,
once email has been set up, say “Call My Email.”)
3. Choose from a listing of information categories like news,
weather, sports, and more.
Note: PCS Voice Command is not available while roaming off the
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
Section 3C: PCS Voice Command
225
Section 4
Safety Guidelines
and
Warranty Information
Section 4A
Safety
In This Section
ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ ࡗ Getting the Most Out of Your Reception
MaintainingSafeUseofandAccesstoYourPhone
CaringfortheBattery
Acknowledging Special Precautions and the FCC Notice
Consumer Information on Wireless Phones
Owner’sRecord
User’s Guide Proprietary Notice
PartofgettingthemostoutofyourPCSVisionPhoneislearninghowthe
phoneworksandhowtocareforit. This section outlines performance
and safety guidelines that help you understand the basic features of
your phone’s operation.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
227
Getting the Most Out ofYour Reception
KeepingTabsonSignalStrength
The quality of each call you make or receive depends on the signal strength in your
area. Your phone informs you of the current signal strength by displaying a number
of bars next to the signal strength icon. The more bars displayed, the stronger the
signal. If you’re inside a building, being near a window may give you better
reception.
Understanding the Power Save Feature
If your phone is unable to find a signal after 15 minutes of searching, a Power Save
feature is automatically activated. If your phone is active, it periodically rechecks
service availability; you can also check it yourself by pressing any key. Anytime the
Power Save feature is activated, a message is displayed on the screen. When a signal
is found, your phone returns to standby mode.
UnderstandingHowYourPhoneOperates
Your phone is basically a radio transmitter and receiver. When it’s turned on, it
receives and transmits radiofrequency (RF) signals. When you use your phone, the
system handling your call controls the power level. This power can range from
0.01µ watts to 0.2 watts in digital mode.
KnowingRadioFrequencySafety
The design of your PCS Vision Phone complies with updated NCRP standards
described below.
In 1991-92, the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) and the
American National Standards Institute (ANSI) joined in updating ANSI’s 1982
standard for safety levels with respect to human exposure to RF signals. More than
120 scientists, engineers and physicians from universities, government health
agencies and industries developed this updated standard after reviewing the
available body of research. In 1993, the Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) adopted this updated standard in a regulation. In August 1996, the FCC
adopted hybrid standard consisting of the existing ANSI/IEEE standard and the
guidelines published by the National Council of Radiation Protection and
Measurements (NCRP).
MaintainingYourPhone’sPeakPerformance
There are several simple guidelines to operating your phone properly and
maintaining safe, satisfactory service.
ⅷ
Hold the phone with the antenna raised, fully-extended, and over your shoulder.
ⅷ
Try not to hold, bend, or twist the phone’s antenna.
ⅷ
Don’t use the phone if the antenna is damaged.
ⅷ
Speak directly into the mouthpiece.
ⅷ
Avoid exposing your phone and accessories to rain or liquid spills. If your phone
does get wet, immediately turn the power off and remove the battery.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
228
Note:For the best care of your phone, only Sprint authorized personnel should service your
phone and accessories. Faulty service may void the warranty.
Maintaining Safe Use of andAccess to
Your Phone
FAILURE TO FOLLOW THE INSTRUCTIONS OUTLINED MAY LEAD TO SERIOUS
PERSONAL INJURY AND POSSIBLE PROPERTY DAMAGE
UsingYourPhoneWhileDriving
Talking on your phone while driving (or operating the phone without a hands-free
device) is prohibited in some jurisdictions. Laws vary as to specific restrictions.
Remember that safety always comes first.
When using your phone in the car:
ⅷ
Get to know your phone and its features, such as speed dial
and redial.
ⅷ
When available, use a hands-free device.
ⅷ
Position your phone within easy reach.
ⅷ
Let the person you are speaking to know you are driving; if necessary, suspend
the call in heavy traffic or hazardous
weather conditions.
ⅷ
Do not take notes or look up phone numbers while driving.
ⅷ
Dial sensibly and assess the traffic; if possible, place calls when stationary or
before pulling into traffic.
ⅷ
Do not engage in stressful or emotional conversations that may divert your
attention from the road.
ⅷ
Dial
to report serious emergencies. It’s free from your
wireless phone.
ⅷ
ⅷ
Use your phone to help others in emergencies.
Call roadside assistance or a special non-emergency wireless number when
necessary.
Tip:Purchase an optional hands-free car kit at your local Sprint Store, or call the PCS Accessory
SM
Hotline at 1-800-974-2221 or by dialing
on your PCS Vision Phone.
FollowingSafetyGuidelines
To operate your phone safely and efficiently, always follow any special regulations
in a given area. Turn your phone off in areas where use is forbidden or when it may
cause interference or danger.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
229
UsingYourPhoneNearOtherElectronicDevices
Most modern electronic equipment is shielded from radiofrequency (RF) signals.
However, RF signals from wireless phones may affect inadequately shielded
electronic equipment.
RF signals may affect improperly installed or inadequately shielded electronic
operating systems and/or entertainment systems in motor vehicles. Check with the
manufacturer or their representative to determine if these systems are adequately
shielded from external RF signals. Also check with the manufacturer regarding any
equipment that has been added to your vehicle.
Consult the manufacturer of any personal medical devices, such as pacemakers and
hearing aids, to determine if they are adequately shielded from external RF signals.
Note:Always turn off the phone in health care facilities and request permission before using the
phone near medical equipment.
TurningOffYourPhoneBeforeFlying
Turn off your phone before boarding any aircraft. To prevent possible interference
with aircraft systems, the U.S. Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) regulations
require you to have permission from a crew member to use your phone while the
plane is on the ground. To prevent any risk of interference, FCC regulations
prohibit using your phone while the plane is in the air.
TurningOffYourPhoneinDangerousAreas
To avoid interfering with blasting operations, turn your phone off when in a
blasting area or in other areas with signs indicating two-way radios should be
turned off. Construction crews often use remote-control RF devices to set off
explosives.
Turn your phone off when you’re in any area that has a potentially explosive
atmosphere. Although it’s rare, your phone and accessories could generate sparks.
Sparks can cause an explosion or fire, resulting in bodily injury or even death.
These areas are often, but not always, clearly marked. They include:
ⅷ
Fueling areas such as gas stations.
ⅷ
Below deck on boats.
ⅷ
Fuel or chemical transfer or storage facilities.
ⅷ
Areas where the air contains chemicals or particles such as grain, dust, or metal
powders.
ⅷ
Any other area where you would normally be advised to turn off your vehicle’s
engine.
Note:Never transport or store flammable gas, liquid or explosives in the compartment of your
vehicle that contains your phone or accessories.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
230
RestrictingChildren’sAccesstoYourPhone
Your phone is not a toy. Do not allow children to play with it as they could hurt
themselves and others, damage the phone or make calls that increase your
PCS Invoice.
Caring for the Battery
ProtectingYourBattery
The guidelines listed below help you get the most out of your battery’s
performance.
ⅷ
Use only Sprint-approved batteries and chargers. These chargers are designed to
maximize battery life. Using other batteries or chargers voids your warranty and
may cause damage.
ⅷ
In order to avoid damage, charge the battery only in temperatures that range
from 32º F to 113º F (0º C to 45º C).
ⅷ
Don’t use the battery charger in direct sunlight or in high humidity areas, such
as the bathroom.
ⅷ
Never dispose of the battery by incineration.
ⅷ
Keep the metal contacts on top of the battery clean.
ⅷ
Don’t attempt to disassemble or short-circuit the battery.
ⅷ
The battery may need recharging if it has not been used for a long period of
time.
ⅷ
It’s best to replace the battery when it no longer provides acceptable
performance. It can be recharged hundreds of times before it needs replacing.
ⅷ
Don’t store the battery in high temperature areas for long periods of time. It’s
best to follow these storage rules:
Less than one month:
4º F to 140º F (-20º C to 60º C)
More than one month:
4º F to 113º F (-20º C to 45º C)
DisposalofLithiumIon(LiIon)Batteries
For safe disposal options of your LiIon batteries, contact your nearest Sprint
authorized service center.
SpecialNote:Be sure to dispose of your battery properly. In some areas, the
disposal of batteries in household or business trash may
be prohibited.
Note:For safety, do not handle a damaged or leaking LiIon battery.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
231
Acknowledging Special Precautions and the
FCC Notice
FCC Notice
This phone may cause TV or radio interference if used in close proximity to
receiving equipment. The FCC can require you to stop using the phone if such
interference cannot be eliminated.
Vehicles using liquefied petroleum gas (propane or butane) must comply with the
National Fire Protection Standard (NFPA-58). For a copy of this standard, contact
the National Fire Protections Association, One Batterymarch Park, Quincy, MA
02269, Attn.: Publication Sales Division.
Cautions
Any changes or modifications to your phone not expressly approved in this
document could void your warranty for this equipment and void your authority to
operate this equipment. Only use approved batteries, antennas and chargers. The
use of any unauthorized accessories may be dangerous and void the phone
warranty if said accessories cause damage or a defect to the phone.
Although your phone is quite sturdy, it is a complex piece of equipment and can be
broken. Avoid dropping, hitting, bending or sitting on it.
Body-WornOperation
To maintain compliance with FCC RF exposure guidelines, if you wear a handset on
your body, use the Sprint supplied or approved carrying case, holster or other
body-worn accessory. If you do not use a body-worn accessory, ensure the antenna
is at least 1.9 cm from your body when transmitting. Use of non-Sprint approved
accessories may violate FCC RF exposure guidelines.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
232
SpecificAbsorptionRates(SAR)forWirelessPhones
The SAR is a value that corresponds to the relative amount of RF energy absorbed in
the head of a user of a wireless handset.
The SAR value of a phone is the result of an extensive testing, measuring and
calculation process. It does not represent how much RF the phone emits. All
phone models are tested at their highest value in strict laboratory settings. But
when in operation, the SAR of a phone can be substantially less than the level
reported to the FCC. This is because of a variety of factors including its proximity to
a base station antenna, phone design and other factors. What is important to
remember is that each phone meets strict federal guidelines. Variations in SARs do
not represent a variation in safety.
All phones must meet the federal standard, which incorporates a substantial
margin of safety. As stated above, variations in SAR values between different model
phones do not mean variations in safety. SAR values at or below the federal standard
of 1.6 W/kg are considered safe for use by the public.
The highest reported SAR values of the PM-8200 are:
AMPS/CDMAmodes(Part22):
Head: 1.30 W/kg; Body-worn: 1.01 W/kg
PCSmode(Part24):
Head: 1.13 W/kg; Body-worn: 1.01 W/kg
FCCRadiofrequencyEmission
This phone meets the FCC Radiofrequency Emission Guidelines.
FCC ID number: AEZSCP-82H. More information on the phone’s SAR can be found
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
233
Consumer Information onWireless Phones
(The following information comes from a consumer information Website jointly
sponsored by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration (FDA) and the Federal
Communications Commission (FCC), entitled “Cell Phone Facts: Consumer
Information on Wireless Phones.” The information reproduced herein is dated
July 29, 2003. For further updates, please visit the Website:
Whatisradiofrequencyenergy(RF)?
Radiofrequency (RF) energy is another name for radio waves. It is one form of
electromagnetic energy that makes up the electromagnetic spectrum. Some of
the other forms of energy in the electromagnetic spectrum are gamma rays, x-
rays and light. Electromagnetic energy (or electromagnetic radiation) consists of
waves of electric and magnetic energy moving together (radiating) through
space. The area where these waves are found is called an electromagnetic field.
Radio waves are created due to the movement of electrical charges in antennas.
As they are created, these waves radiate away from the antenna. All
electromagnetic waves travel at the speed of light. The major differences
between the different types of waves are the distances covered by one cycle of
the wave and the number of waves that pass a certain point during a set time
period. The wavelength is the distance covered by one cycle of a wave. The
frequency is the number of waves passing a given point in one second. For any
electromagnetic wave, the wavelength multiplied by the frequency equals the
speed of light. The frequency of an RF signal is usually expressed in units called
hertz (Hz). One Hz equals one wave per second. One kilohertz (kHz) equals one
thousand waves per second, one megahertz (MHz) equals one million waves per
second, and one gigahertz (GHz) equals one billion waves per second.
RF energy includes waves with frequencies ranging from about 3000 waves per
second (3 kHz) to 300 billion waves per second (300 GHz). Microwaves are a
subset of radio waves that have frequencies ranging from around 300 million
waves per second (300 MHz) to three billion waves per second (3 GHz).
Howisradiofrequencyenergyused?
Probably the most important use of RF energy is for telecommunications. Radio
and TV broadcasting, wireless phones, pagers, cordless phones, police and fire
department radios, point-to-point links and satellite communications all rely on
RF energy.
Other uses of RF energy include microwave ovens, radar, industrial heaters and
sealers, and medical treatments. RF energy, especially at microwave
frequencies, can heat water. Since most food has a high water content,
microwaves can cook food quickly. Radar relies on RF energy to track cars and
airplanes as well as for military applications. Industrial heaters and sealers use
RF energy to mold plastic materials, glue wood products, seal leather items such
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
234
as shoes and pocketbooks, and process food. Medical uses of RF energy include
pacemaker monitoring and programming.
Howisradiofrequencyradiationmeasured?
RF waves and RF fields have both electrical and magnetic components. It is
often convenient to express the strength of the RF field in terms of each
component. For example, the unit “volts per meter” (V/m) is used to measure
the electric field strength, and the unit “amperes per meter” (A/m) is used to
express the magnetic field strength. Another common way to characterize an RF
field is by means of the power density. Power density is defined as power per
unit area. For example, power density can be expressed in terms of milliwatts
(one thousandth of a watt) per square centimeter (mW/cm2 or microwatts (one
millionth of a watt) per square centimeter (µW/cm2).
The quantity used to measure how much RF energy is actually absorbed by the
body is called the Specific Absorption Rate or SAR. The SAR is a measure of the
rate of absorption of RF energy. It is usually expressed in units of watts per
kilogram (W/kg) or milliwatts per gram (mW/g).
WhatbiologicaleffectscanbecausedbyRFenergy?
The biological effects of radiofrequency energy should not be confused with the
effects from other types of electromagnetic energy.
Very high levels of electromagnetic energy, such as is found in X-rays and gamma
rays can ionize biological tissues. Ionization is a process where electrons are
stripped away from their normal locations in atoms and molecules. It can
permanently damage biological tissues including DNA, the genetic material.
Ionization only occurs with very high levels of electromagnetic energy such as
X-rays and gamma rays. Often the term radiation is used when discussing
ionizing radiation (such as that associated with nuclear power plants).
The energy levels associated with radiofrequency energy, including both radio
waves and microwaves, are not great enough to cause the ionization of atoms
and molecules. Therefore, RF energy is a type of non-ionizing radiation. Other
types of non-ionizing radiation include visible light, infrared radiation (heat) and
other forms of electromagnetic radiation with relatively low frequencies.
Large amounts of RF energy can heat tissue. This can damage tissues and
increase body temperatures. Two areas of the body, the eyes and the testes, are
particularly vulnerable to RF heating because there is relatively little blood flow
in them to carry away excess heat.
The amount of RF radiation routinely encountered by the general public is too
low to produce significant heating or increased body temperature. Still, some
people have questions about the possible health effects of low levels of RF
energy. It is generally agreed that further research is needed to determine what
effects actually occur and whether they are dangerous to people. In the
meantime, standards-setting organizations and government agencies are
continuing to monitor the latest scientific findings to determine whether
changes in safety limits are needed to protect human health.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
235
FDA, EPA and other US government agencies responsible for public health and
safety have worked together and in connection with WHO to monitor
developments and identify research needs related to RF biological effects.
WhatlevelsofRFenergyareconsideredsafe?
Various organizations and countries have developed standards for exposure to
radiofrequency energy. These standards recommend safe levels of exposure for
both the general public and for workers. In the United States, the FCC has used
safety guidelines for RF environmental exposure since 1985.
The FCC guidelines for human exposure to RF electromagnetic fields are
derived from the recommendations of two expert organizations, the National
Council on Radiation Protection and Measurements (NCRP) and the Institute of
Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE). In both cases, the recommendations
were developed by scientific and engineering experts drawn from industry,
government, and academia after extensive reviews of the scientific literature
related to the biological effects of RF energy.
Many countries in Europe and elsewhere use exposure guidelines developed by
the International Commission on Non-Ionizing Radiation Protection (ICNIRP).
The ICNIRP safety limits are generally similar to those of the NCRP and IEEE,
with a few exceptions. For example, ICNIRP recommends different exposure
levels in the lower and upper frequency ranges and for localized exposure from
certain products such as hand-held wireless telephones. Currently, the World
Health Organization is working to provide a framework for international
harmonization of RF safety standards.
The NCRP, IEEE, and ICNIRP all have identified a whole-body Specific
Absorption Rate (SAR) value of 4 watts per kilogram (4 W/kg) as a threshold
level of exposure at which harmful biological effects may occur. Exposure
guidelines in terms of field strength, power density and localized SAR were then
derived from this threshold value. In addition, the NCRP, IEEE, and ICNIRP
guidelines vary depending on the frequency of the RF exposure. This is due to
the finding that whole-body human absorption of RF energy varies with the
frequency of the RF signal. The most restrictive limits on whole-body exposure
are in the frequency range of 30-300 MHz where the human body absorbs RF
energy most efficiently. For products that only expose part of the body, such as
wireless phones, exposure limits in terms of SAR only are specified.
The exposure limits used by the FCC are expressed in terms of SAR, electric and
magnetic field strength, and power density for transmitters operating at
frequencies from 300 kHz to 100 GHz. The specific values can be found in two
FCC bulletins, OET Bulletins 56 and 65:
WhyhastheFCCadoptedguidelinesforRFexposure?
The FCC authorizes and licenses products, transmitters, and facilities that
generate RF and microwave radiation. It has jurisdiction over all transmitting
services in the U.S. except those specifically operated by the Federal
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
236
Government. While the FCC does not have the expertise to determine radiation
exposure guidelines on its own, it does have the expertise and authority to
recognize and adopt technically sound standards promulgated by other expert
agencies and organizations, and has done so . (Our joint efforts with the FDA in
developing this website is illustrative of the kind of inter-agency efforts and
consultation we engage in regarding this health and safety issue.)
Under the National Environmental Policy Act of 1969 (NEPA), the FCC has
certain responsibilities to consider whether its actions will significantly affect
the quality of the human environment. Therefore, FCC approval and licensing of
transmitters and facilities must be evaluated for significant impact on the
environment. Human exposure to RF radiation emitted by FCC-regulated
transmitters is one of several factors that must be considered in such
environmental evaluations. In 1996, the FCC revised its guidelines for RF
exposure as a result of a multi-year proceeding and as required by the
Telecommunications Act of 1996.
Radio and television broadcast stations, satellite-earth stations, experimental
radio stations and certain wireless communication facilities are required to
undergo routine evaluation for RF compliance when they submit an application
to the FCC for construction or modification of a transmitting facility or renewal
of a license. Failure to comply with the FCC’s RF exposure guidelines could lead
to the preparation of a formal Environmental Assessment, possible
Environmental Impact Statement and eventual rejection of an application.
Technical guidelines for evaluating compliance with the FCC RF safety
requirements can be found in the FCC’s OET Bulletin 65.
Low-powered, intermittent, or inaccessible RF transmitters and facilities are
normally excluded from the requirement for routine evaluation for RF exposure.
These exclusions are based on standard calculations and measurement data
indicating that a transmitting station or equipment operating under the
conditions prescribed is unlikely to cause exposures in excess of the guidelines
under normal conditions of use. Such exclusions are not exclusions from
compliance, but, rather, exclusions from routine evaluation. The FCC’s policies
on RF exposure and categorical exclusion can be found in Section 1.1307(b) of
the FCC’s Rules and Regulations [(47 CFR 1.1307(b)].
HowcanIobtaintheSpecificAbsorptionRate(SAR)valueformy
wirelessphone?
The FCC requires that wireless phones sold in the United States demonstrate
compliance with human exposure limits adopted by the FCC in 1996. The
relative amount of RF energy absorbed in the head of a wireless telephone-user
is given by the Specific Absorption Rate (SAR), as explained above. The FCC
requires wireless phones to comply with a safety limit of 1.6 watts per kilogram
(1.6 W/kg) in terms of SAR.
Information on SAR for a specific phone model can be obtained for many
recently manufactured phones using the FCC identification (ID) number for that
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
237
model. The FCC ID number is usually printed somewhere on the case of the
phone. Sometimes it may be necessary to remove the battery pack to find the
number. Once you have the ID number, go to the following Web address:
www.fcc.gov/oet/fccid. On this page, you will see instructions for entering the
FCC ID number. Type the FCC ID number exactly as requested (the Grantee
Code is the first three characters, the Equipment Product Code is the rest of the
FCC ID number). Then click on “Start Search.” The “Grant of Equipment
Authorization” for your telephone should appear. Read through the grant for the
section on “SAR Compliance,” “Certification of Compliance with FCC Rules for
RF Exposure” or similar language. This section should contain the value(s) for
typical or maximum SAR for your phone.
Phones and other products authorized since June 2, 2000, should have the
maximum SAR levels noted directly on the “Grant of Equipment Authorization.”
For phones and products authorized between about mid-1998 and June 2000,
detailed information on SAR levels is typically found in the exhibits associated
with the grant. Once a grant is accessed, the exhibits can be viewed by clicking
on “View Exhibit.” Grants authorized prior to 1998 are not part of the electronic
database but, rather, have been documented in the form of paper records.
The FCC database does not list phones by model number. However, consumers
may find SAR information from other sources as well. Some wireless phone
manufacturers make SAR information available on their own Web sites. In
addition, some non-government Web sites provide SARs for specific models of
wireless phones. However, the FCC has not reviewed these sites and makes no
guarantees of their accuracy. Finally, phones certified by the Cellular
Telecommunications and Internet Association (CTIA) are required to provide
SAR information to consumers in the instructional materials that come with
the phones.
Dohands-freekitsforwirelessphonesreducerisksfromexposuretoRF
emissions?
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF emissions from wireless
phones, there is no reason to believe that hands-free kits reduce risks. Hands-
free kits can be used with wireless phones for convenience and comfort. These
systems reduce the absorption of RF energy in the head because the phone,
which is the source of the RF emissions, will not be placed against the head. On
the other hand, if the phone is mounted against the waist or other part of the
body during use, then that part of the body will absorb more RF energy. Wireless
phones marketed in the U.S. are required to meet safety requirements regardless
of whether they are used against the head or against the body. Either
configuration should result in compliance with the safety limit.
DowirelessphoneaccessoriesthatclaimtoshieldtheheadfromRF
radiationwork?
Since there are no known risks from exposure to RF emissions from wireless
phones, there is no reason to believe that accessories that claim to shield the
head from those emissions reduce risks. Some products that claim to shield the
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
238
user from RF absorption use special phone cases, while others involve nothing
more than a metallic accessory attached to the phone. Studies have shown that
these products generally do not work as advertised. Unlike “hand-free” kits,
these so-called “shields” may interfere with proper operation of the phone. The
phone may be forced to boost its power to compensate, leading to an increase in
RF absorption. In February 2002, the Federal trade Commission (FTC) charged
two companies that sold devices that claimed to protect wireless phone users
from radiation with making false and unsubstantiated claims. According to FTC,
these defendants lacked a reasonable basis to substantiate their claim.
Whatarewirelesstelephonebasestations?
Fixed antennas used for wireless telecommunications are referred to as cellular
base stations, cell stations, PCS (“Personal Communications Service”) stations or
telephone transmission towers. These base stations consist of antennas and
electronic equipment. Because the antennas need to be high in the air, they are
often located on towers, poles, water tanks, or rooftops. Typical heights for
freestanding base station towers are 50-200 feet.
Some base stations use antennas that look like poles, 10 to 15 feet in length, that
are referred to as “omni-directional” antennas. These types of antennas are
usually found in rural areas. In urban and suburban areas, wireless providers
now more commonly use panel or sector antennas for their base stations. These
antennas consist of rectangular panels, about 1 by 4 feet in dimension. The
antennas are usually arranged in three groups of three antennas each. One
antenna in each group is used to transmit signals to wireless phones, and the
other two antennas in each group are used to receive signals from wireless
phones.
At any base station site, the amount of RF energy produced depends on the
number of radio channels (transmitters) per antenna and the power of each
transmitter. Typically, 21 channels per antenna sector are available. For a typical
cell site using sector antennas, each of the three transmitting antennas could be
connected to up to 21 transmitters for a total of 63 transmitters. However, it is
unlikely that all of the transmitters would be transmitting at the same time.
When omni-directional antennas are used, a cellular base station could
theoretically use up to 96 transmitters, but this would be very unusual, and,
once again, it is unlikely that all transmitters would be in operation
simultaneously. Base stations used for PCS communications generally require
fewer transmitters than those used for cellular radio transmissions, since PCS
carriers usually have a higher density of base station antenna sites.
Arewirelesstelephonebasestationssafe?
The electromagnetic RF signals transmitted from base station antennas stations
travel toward the horizon in relatively narrow paths. For example, the radiation
pattern for an antenna array mounted on a tower can be likened to a thin
pancake centered around the antenna system. The individual pattern for a single
array of sector antennas is wedge-shaped, like a piece of pie. As with all forms of
electromagnetic energy, the power decreases rapidly as one moves away from
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
239
the antenna. Therefore, RF exposure on the ground is much less than exposure
very close to the antenna and in the path of the transmitted radio signal. In fact,
ground-level exposure from such antennas is typically thousands of times less
than the exposure levels recommended as safe by expert organizations. So
exposure to nearby residents would be well within safety margins.
Cellular and PCS base stations in the United States are required to comply with
limits for exposure recommended by expert organizations and endorsed by
government agencies responsible for health and safety. Measurements made
near cellular and PCS base station antennas mounted on towers have confirmed
that ground-level exposures are typically thousands of times less than the
exposure limits adopted by the FCC. In fact, in order to be exposed to levels at or
near the FCC limits for cellular or PCS frequencies an individual would
essentially have to remain in the main transmitted radio signal (at the height of
the antenna) and within a few feet from the antenna. This is, of course, very
unlikely to occur.
When cellular and PCS antennas are mounted on rooftops, RF levels on that roof
or on others near by would probably be greater than those typically
encountered on the ground. However, exposure levels approaching or
exceeding safety guidelines should be encountered only very close to or directly
in front of the antennas. In addition, for sector-type antennas, typically used for
such rooftop base stations, RF levels to the side and in back of these antennas are
insignificant. General guidelines on antenna installations and circumstances
that might give rise to a concern about an facility’s conformance with FCC
regulations can be found in A Local Government Official’s Guide to
TransmittingAntenna RF Emission Safety:Rules, Procedures, and Practical
Whoregulatesexposuretoradiationfrommicrowaveovens, televisionsets
andcomputermonitors?
The Food and Drug Administration is responsible for protecting the public from
harmful radiation emissions from these consumer products.
DoestheFCCroutinelymonitorradiofrequencyradiationfromantennas?
The FCC does not have the resources or the personnel to routinely monitor the
emissions for all the thousands of transmitters that are subject to FCC
jurisdiction. However, the FCC does have measurement instrumentation for
evaluating RF levels in areas that may be accessible to the public or to workers. If
there is evidence for potential non-compliance with FCC exposure guidelines
for a FCC-regulated facility, staff from the FCC’s Office of Engineering and
Technology or the FCC Enforcement Bureau can conduct and investigation, and,
if appropriate, perform actual measurements. Circumstances that could give
rise to a concern about an facility’s conformance with FCC regulations can be
found in in A Local Government Official’s Guide toTransmittingAntenna RF
Emission Safety:Rules, Procedures, and Practical Guidance. This Guide can be
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
240
be brought to the FCC’s attention by contacting the FCC RF Safety Program at:
DoestheFCCmaintainadatabasethatincludesinformationonthelocation
andtechnicalparametersofallthetransmittingtowersitregulates?
Each of the FCC Bureaus maintains its own licensing database system for the
service(s) it regulates (e.g., television, cellular service, satellite earth stations.)
The FCC issues two types of licenses: site specific and market based. In the case
of site specific licensed facilities, technical operating information is collected
from the licensee as part of the licensing process. However, in the case of
market based licensing (e.g., PCS, cellular), the licensee is granted the authority
to operate a radio communications system in a geographic area using as many
facilities as are required, and the licensee is not required to provide the FCC with
specific location and operating parameters of these facilities.
Information on site specific licensed facilities can be found the “General Menu
The various FCC Bureaus also publish on at least a weekly basis, bulk extracts of
their licensing databases. Each licensing database has its own unique file
structure. These extracts consist of multiple, very large files. The FCC’s Office of
Engineering and Technology (OET) maintains an index to these databases at
http://www.fcc.gov/oet/info/database/fadb.html. Entry points into the various
databases include frequency, state/county, latitude/longitude, call-sign and
licensee name. For further information on the Commission’s existing databases,
Canlocalandstategovernmentalbodiesestablishlimitsfor
RFexposure?
Although some local and state governments have enacted rules and regulations
about human exposure to RF energy in the past, the Telecommunications Act of
1996 requires the Federal Government to control human exposure to RF
emissions. In particular, Section 704 of the Act states that, “No State or local
government or instrumentality thereof may regulate the placement,
construction, and modification of personal wireless service facilities on the
basis of the environmental effects of radio frequency emissions to the extent
that such facilities comply with the Commission’s regulations concerning such
emissions.” Further information on federal authority and FCC policy is available
in a fact sheet from the FCC’s Wireless Telecommunications Bureau at
Dowirelessphonesposeahealthhazard?
The available scientific evidence does not show that any health problems are
associated with using wireless phones. There is no proof, however, that wireless
phones are absolutely safe. Wireless phones emit low levels of radiofrequency
energy (RF) in the microwave range while being used. They also emit very low
levels of RF when in the stand-by mode. Whereas high levels of RF can produce
health effects (by heating tissue), exposure to low level RF that does not
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
241
produce heating effects causes no known adverse health effects. Many studies
of low level RF exposures have not found any biological effects. Some studies
have suggested that some biological effects may occur, but such findings have
not been confirmed by additional research. In some cases, other researchers
have had difficulty in reproducing those studies, or in determining the reasons
for inconsistent results.
WhatisFDA’sroleconcerningthesafetyofwirelessphones?
Under the law, FDA does not review the safety of radiation-emitting consumer
products such as wireless phones before they can be sold, as it does with new
drugs or medical devices. However, the agency has authority to take action if
wireless phones are shown to emit radiofrequency energy (RF) at a level that is
hazardous to the user. In such a case, FDA could require the manufacturers of
wireless phones to notify users of the health hazard and to repair, replace or
recall the phones so that the hazard no longer exists.
Although the existing scientific data do not justify FDA regulatory actions, FDA
has urged the wireless phone industry to take a number of steps, including the
following:
Ⅲ
Support needed research into possible biological effects of RF of the
type emitted by wireless phones;
Ⅲ
Design wireless phones in a way that minimizes any RF exposure to the
user that is not necessary for device function; and
Ⅲ
Cooperate in providing users of wireless phones with the best possible
information on possible effects of wireless phone use on human health
FDA belongs to an interagency working group of the federal agencies that have
responsibility for different aspects of RF safety to ensure coordinated efforts at
the federal level. The following agencies belong to this working group:
Ⅲ
National Institute for Occupational Safety and Health
Ⅲ
Environmental Protection Agency
Ⅲ
Federal Communications Commission
Ⅲ
Occupational Safety and Health Administration
Ⅲ
National Telecommunications and Information Administration
The National Institutes of Health participates in some interagency working
group activities, as well.
FDA shares regulatory responsibilities for wireless phones with the Federal
Communications Commission (FCC). All phones that are sold in the United
States must comply with FCC safety guidelines that limit RF exposure. FCC relies
on FDA and other health agencies for safety questions about wireless phones.
FCC also regulates the base stations that the wireless phone networks rely upon.
While these base stations operate at higher power than do the wireless phones
themselves, the RF exposures that people get from these base stations are
typically thousands of times lower than those they can get from wireless
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
242
phones. Base stations are thus not the primary subject of the safety questions
discussed in this document.
Whatkindsofphonesarethesubjectofthisupdate?
The term “wireless phone” refers here to hand-held wireless phones with built-
in antennas, often called “cell,” “mobile,” or “PCS” phones. These types of
wireless phones can expose the user to measurable radiofrequency energy (RF)
because of the short distance between the phone and the user’s head. These RF
exposures are limited by Federal Communications Commission safety
guidelines that were developed with the advice of FDA and other federal health
and safety agencies. When the phone is located at greater distances from the
user, the exposure to RF is drastically lower because a person’s RF exposure
decreases rapidly with increasing distance from the source. The so-called
“cordless phones,” which have a base unit connected to the telephone wiring in
a house, typically operate at far lower power levels, and thus produce RF
exposures well within the FCC’s compliance limits.
Whataretheresultsoftheresearchdonealready?
The research done thus far has produced conflicting results, and many studies
have suffered from flaws in their research methods. Animal experiments
investigating the effects of radiofrequency energy (RF) exposures characteristic
of wireless phones have yielded conflicting results that often cannot be
repeated in other laboratories. A few animal studies, however, have suggested
that low levels of RF could accelerate the development of cancer in laboratory
animals. However, many of the studies that showed increased tumor
development used animals that had been genetically engineered or treated with
cancer-causing chemicals so as to be pre-disposed to develop cancer in the
absence of RF exposure. Other studies exposed the animals to RF for up to 22
hours per day. These conditions are not similar to the conditions under which
people use wireless phones, so we don’t know with certainty what the results of
such studies mean for human health.
Three large epidemiology studies have been published since December 2000.
Between them, the studies investigated any possible association between the
use of wireless phones and primary brain cancer, glioma, meningioma, or
acoustic neuroma, tumors of the brain or salivary gland, leukemia, or other
cancers. None of the studies demonstrated the existence of any harmful health
effects from wireless phone RF exposures. However, none of the studies can
answer questions about long-term exposures, since the average period of phone
use in these studies was around three years.
WhatresearchisneededtodecidewhetherRFexposurefromwireless
phonesposesahealthrisk?
A combination of laboratory studies and epidemiological studies of people
actually using wireless phones would provide some of the data that are needed.
Lifetime animal exposure studies could be completed in a few years. However,
very large numbers of animals would be needed to provide reliable proof of a
cancer promoting effect if one exists. Epidemiological studies can provide data
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
243
that is directly applicable to human populations, but 10 or more years’ follow-up
may be needed to provide answers about some health effects, such as cancer.
This is because the interval between the time of exposure to a cancer-causing
agent and the time tumors develop - if they do - may be many, many years. The
interpretation of epidemiological studies is hampered by difficulties in
measuring actual RF exposure during day-to-day use of wireless phones. Many
factors affect this measurement, such as the angle at which the phone is held, or
which model of phone is used.
WhatisFDAdoingtofindoutmoreaboutthepossiblehealtheffectsof
wirelessphoneRF?
FDA is working with the U.S. National Toxicology Program and with groups of
investigators around the world to ensure that high priority animal studies are
conducted to address important questions about the effects of exposure to
radiofrequency energy (RF).
FDA has been a leading participant in the World Health Organization
International Electromagnetic Fields (EMF) Project since its inception in 1996.
An influential result of this work has been the development of a detailed agenda
of research needs that has driven the establishment of new research programs
around the world. The Project has also helped develop a series of public
information documents on EMF issues.
FDA and the Cellular Telecommunications & Internet Association (CTIA) have a
formal Cooperative Research and Development Agreement (CRADA) to do
research on wireless phone safety. FDA provides the scientific oversight,
obtaining input from experts in government, industry, and academic
organizations. CTIA-funded research is conducted through contracts to
independent investigators. The initial research will include both laboratory
studies and studies of wireless phone users. The CRADA will also include a
broad assessment of additional research needs in the context of the latest
research developments around the world.
WhatstepscanItaketoreducemyexposuretoradiofrequencyenergyfrom
mywirelessphone?
If there is a risk from these products--and at this point we do not know that there
is--it is probably very small. But if you are concerned about avoiding even
potential risks, you can take a few simple steps to minimize your exposure to
radiofrequency energy (RF). Since time is a key factor in how much exposure a
person receives, reducing the amount of time spent using a wireless phone will
reduce RF exposure.
Ⅲ
If you must conduct extended conversations by wireless phone every day,
you could place more distance between your body and the source of the
RF, since the exposure level drops off dramatically with distance. For
example, you could use a headset and carry the wireless phone away from
your body or use a wireless phone connected to a remote antenna.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
244
Again, the scientific data do not demonstrate that wireless phones are harmful.
But if you are concerned about the RF exposure from these products, you can
use measures like those described above to reduce your RF exposure from
wireless phone use.
Whataboutchildrenusingwirelessphones?
The scientific evidence does not show a danger to users of wireless phones,
including children and teenagers. If you want to take steps to lower exposure to
radiofrequency energy (RF), the measures described above would apply to
children and teenagers using wireless phones. Reducing the time of wireless
phone use and increasing the distance between the user and the RF source will
reduce RF exposure.
Some groups sponsored by other national governments have advised that
children be discouraged from using wireless phones at all. For example, the
government in the United Kingdom distributed leaflets containing such a
recommendation in December 2000. They noted that no evidence exists that
using a wireless phone causes brain tumors or other ill effects. Their
recommendation to limit wireless phone use by children was strictly
precautionary; it was not based on scientific evidence that any health hazard
exists.
Whataboutwirelessphoneinterferencewithmedicalequipment?
Radiofrequency energy (RF) from wireless phones can interact with some
electronic devices. For this reason, FDA helped develop a detailed test method
to measure electromagnetic interference (EMI) of implanted cardiac
pacemakers and defibrillators from wireless telephones. This test method is
now part of a standard sponsored by the Association for the Advancement of
Medical instrumentation (AAMI). The final draft, a joint effort by FDA, medical
device manufacturers, and many other groups, was completed in late 2000. This
standard will allow manufacturers to ensure that cardiac pacemakers and
defibrillators are safe from wireless phone EMI.
FDA has tested hearing aids for interference from handheld wireless phones and
helped develop a voluntary standard sponsored by the Institute of Electrical and
Electronic Engineers (IEEE). This standard specifies test methods and
performance requirements for hearing aids and wireless phones so that that no
interference occurs when a person uses a “compatible” phone and a
“compatible” hearing aid at the same time. This standard was approved by the
IEEE in 2000.
FDA continues to monitor the use of wireless phones for possible interactions
with other medical devices. Should harmful interference be found to occur, FDA
will conduct testing to assess the interference and work to resolve the problem.
WhichotherfederalagencieshaveresponsibilitiesrelatedtopotentialRF
healtheffects?
Certain agencies in the Federal Government have been involved in monitoring,
researching or regulating issues related to human exposure to RF radiation.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
245
These agencies include the Food and Drug Administration (FDA), the
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), the Occupational Safety and Health
Administration (OSHA), the National Institute for Occupational Safety and
Health (NIOSH), the National Telecommunications and Information
Administration (NTIA) and the Department of Defense (DOD).
By authority of the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act of 1968, the
Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) of the FDA develops
performance standards for the emission of radiation from electronic products
including X-ray equipment, other medical devices, television sets, microwave
ovens, laser products and sunlamps. The CDRH established a product
performance standard for microwave ovens in 1971 limiting the amount of RF
leakage from ovens. However, the CDRH has not adopted performance
standards for other RF-emitting products. The FDA is, however, the lead federal
health agency in monitoring the latest research developments and advising
other agencies with respect to the safety of RF-emitting products used by the
public, such as cellular and PCS phones.
The FDA’s microwave oven standard is an emission standard (as opposed to an
exposure standard) that allows specific levels of microwave leakage (measured
at five centimeters from the oven surface). The standard also requires ovens to
have two independent interlock systems that prevent the oven from generating
microwaves the moment that the latch is released or the door of the oven is
opened. The FDA has stated that ovens that meet its standards and are used
according to the manufacturer’s recommendations are safe for consumer and
The EPA has, in the past, considered developing federal guidelines for public
exposure to RF radiation. However, EPA activities related to RF safety and health
are presently limited to advisory functions. For example, the EPA now chairs an
Inter-agency Radiofrequency Working Group, which coordinates RF health-
related activities among the various federal agencies with health or regulatory
responsibilities in this area.
OSHA is responsible for protecting workers from exposure to hazardous
chemical and physical agents. In 1971, OSHA issued a protection guide for
exposure of workers to RF radiation [29 CFR 1910.97]. However, this guide was
later ruled to be only advisory and not mandatory. Moreover, it was based on an
earlier RF exposure standard that has now been revised. At the present time,
OSHA uses the IEEE and/or FCC exposure guidelines for enforcement purposes
under OSHA’s “general duty clause” (for more information see:http://www.osha-
NIOSH is part of the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services. It conducts
research and investigations into issues related to occupational exposure to
chemical and physical agents. NIOSH has, in the past, undertaken to develop RF
exposure guidelines for workers, but final guidelines were never adopted by the
agency. NIOSH conducts safety-related RF studies through its Physical Agents
Effects Branch in Cincinnati,Ohio.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
246
The NTIA is an agency of the U.S. Department of Commerce and is responsible
for authorizing Federal Government use of the RF electromagnetic spectrum.
Like the FCC, the NTIA also has NEPA responsibilities and has considered
adopting guidelines for evaluating RF exposure from U.S. Government
transmitters such as radar and military facilities.
The Department of Defense (DOD) has conducted research on the biological
effects of RF energy for a number of years. This research is now conducted
primarily at the U.S. Air Force Research Laboratory located at Brooks Air Force
Base, Texas. The DOD Web site for RF biological effects information is listed
with other sites in conjunction with a question on other sources of information,
below.
Whofundsandcarriesoutresearchonthebiologicaleffectsof
RFenergy?
Research into possible biological effects of RF energy is carried out in
laboratories in the United States and around the world. In the U.S., most
research has been funded by the Department of Defense, due to the extensive
military use of RF equipment such as radar and high-powered radio transmitters.
In addition, some federal agencies responsible for health and safety, such as the
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and the U.S. Food and Drug
Administration (FDA), have sponsored and conducted research in this area. At
the present time, most of the non-military research on biological effects of RF
energy in the U.S. is being funded by industry organizations. More research is
being carried out overseas, particularly in Europe.
In 1996, the World Health Organization (WHO) established the International
EMF Project to review the scientific literature and work towards resolution of
health concerns over the use of RF technology. WHO maintains a Web site that
provides extensive information on this project and about RF biological effects
FDA, EPA and other US government agencies responsible for public health and
safety have worked together and in connection with WHO to monitor
developments and identify research needs related to RF biological effects.
HowdoesFCCAuditCellPhoneRF?
After FCC grants permission for a particular cellular telephone to be marketed,
FCC will occasionally conduct “post-grant” testing to determine whether
production versions of the phone are being produced to conform with FCC
regulatory requirements. The manufacturer of a cell phone that does not meet
FCC’s regulatory requirements may be required to remove the cell phone from
use and to refund the purchase price or provide a replacement phone, and may
be subject to civil or criminal penalties. In addition, if the cell phone presents a
risk of injury to the user, FDA may also take regulatory action. The most
important post-grant test, from a consumer’s perspective, is testing of the RF
emissions of the phone. FCC measures the Specific Absorption Rate (SAR) of the
phone, following a very rigorous testing protocol. As is true for nearly any
scientific measurement, there is a possibility that the test measurement may be
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
247
less than or greater than the actual RF emitted by the phone. This difference
between the RF test measurement and actual RF emission is because test
measurements are limited by instrument accuracy, because test measurement
and actual use environments are different, and other variable factors. This
inherent variability is known as “measurement uncertainty.” When FCC
conducts post-grant testing of a cell phone, FCC takes into account any
measurement uncertainty to when determining whether regulatory action is
appropriate. This approach ensures that when FCC takes regulatory action, it
will have a sound, defensible scientific basis.
FDA scientific staff reviewed the methodology used by FCC to measure cell
phone RF, and agreed it is an acceptable approach, given our current
understanding of the risks presented by cellular phone RF emissions. RF
emissions from cellular phones have not been shown to present a risk of injury
to the user when the measured SAR is less than the safety limits set by FCC (an
SAR of 1.6 w/kg). Even in a case where the maximum measurement uncertainty
permitted by current measurement standards was added to the maximum
permissible SAR, the resulting SAR value would be well below any level known
to produce an acute effect. Consequently, FCC’s approach with measurement
uncertainty will not result in consumers being exposed to any known risk from
the RF emitted by cellular telephones.
FDA will continue to monitor studies and literature reports concerning acute
effects of cell phone RF, and concerning chronic effects of long-term exposure
to cellular telephone RF (that is, the risks from using a cell phone for many
years). If new information leads FDA to believe that a change to FCC’s
measurement policy may be appropriate, FDA will contact FCC and both
agencies will work together to develop a mutually-acceptable approach.
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
248
Owner’s Record
The model number, regulatory number and serial number are located on a
nameplate inside the battery compartment. Record the serial number in the space
provided below. This will be helpful if you need to contact us about your phone in
the future.
SM
Model: PCS Vision Picture Phone PM-8200 by Sanyo
Serial No.:
User’s Guide Proprietary Notice
CDMA Technology is licensed by QUALCOMM Incorporated under one or more of
the following patents:
4,901,307 5,109,390 5,267,262 5,416,797
5,506,865 5,544,196 5,657,420 5,101,501
5,267,261 5,414,796 5,504,773 5,535,239
5,600,754 5,778,338 5,228,054 5,337,338
5,710,784 5,056,109 5,568,483 5,659,569
5,490,165 5,511,073
T9 Text Input is licensed by Tegic Communications and is covered by U.S. Pat.
5,818,437, U.S. Pat. 5,953,541, U.S. Pat. 6,011,554 and other patents pending.
User’s Guide template version 3D (09-01-03)
Section 4A: Safety Guidelines
249
Section 4B
Terms & Conditions and
Manufacturer’s Warranty
In This Section
ࡗ TermsandConditions
ࡗ Manufacturer’sWarranty
YourPCSVisionPhonehasbeendesignedtoprovideyouwithreliable,
worry-freeservice. If for any reason you have a problem with your
equipment, please refer to the manufacturer’s warranty.
This section contains the Terms and Conditions of Service for
your PCS Phone and Service and the manufacturer’s warranty for
your PCS Phone.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
250
Terms and Conditions
TermsandConditionsofServices
(Effective as of November 24, 2003 until replaced)
Thanks for choosing Sprint. These terms and conditions are part of your agreement
with Sprint for PCS Services.
The terms and conditions included with your PCS Phone may not be the most
current version. For the most current version of the terms and conditions, please
1-888-211-4PCS. If you activated PCS Services before the effective date of these
terms and conditions, these terms and conditions replace and supersede any
previous terms and conditions.
If you have questions about your PCS Services, please visit our website at
www.sprintpcs.com or call PCS Customer Service Solutions at
1-888-211-4PCS (4727).
Para solicitar esta literatura en español, por favor contactar a
1-888-211-4PCS(4727).
Agreement. Your agreement (“Agreement”) with Sprint Spectrum L.P. and any of its
affiliates doing business as Sprint providing PCS Services (“Services”) to you is made
up of these Terms and Conditions of Service (“Terms”) and the Service Plan that we
agree to provide you. Your “Service Plan” is described in our marketing materials,
and includes the terms, rates and features we set for that Service Plan. In the
agreement, we use the words “we,” “us,” “our” or “Sprint” to refer to Sprint
Spectrum L.P. and its affiliates doing business as Sprint. You accept the agreement
when you activate PCS Services or make any attempt to use our PCS Services (for
example, attempting to place any call while on or roaming off the Sprint Nationwide
PCS Network, using data services, etc.). We may change the Agreement at any time
by giving you prior notice. Any changes to the Agreement are effective when we
publish them. If you use our Services or make any payment to us on or after the
effective date of the changes, you accept the changes. If we change a material term
of the Agreement and that change has a material adverse effect on you, you may
terminate the Agreement without an early termination fee by calling 1-888-211-4727
within 30 days after the invoice date of the first invoice your receive after the
changes go into effect. You understand and agree that taxes, Universal Service fees
and other charges imposed by the government or based on government calculations
may increase or decrease on a monthly basis, and that this paragraph does not apply
to any increases in such taxes, Universal Service fees and other charges.
ProvisionofService. Your purchase of a PCS Phone or other equipment does not
mean that we must provide Services to you. We may decide not to provide Services to
you for any lawful reason. We may request that you provide us with any information
we reasonably require to determine whether you qualify for Services. Services in
some areas are managed and provided under contract with Sprint by independent
affiliates with access to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. Some Services may not
be available or may operate differently in certain affiliate markets or other areas.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
251
CreditVerification. You must have and maintain satisfactory credit to receive and
continue to receive Services. We will verify your credit before agreeing to provide
Services to you and we may verify your credit at any time while we provide Services
to you. Credit verification may include a review of credit reports that we receive from
credit bureaus. If at any time we determine, in our sole discretion, that payment for
Services may not be made when due, we may suspend Services and require that you
provide payment on account or a guarantee of payment before we resume Services.
ServicePlan. You may be eligible for a fixed length PCS Service Plan (“Term Service
Plan”) or for a month-to-month Service Plan (“Non-Term Service Plan”). We
determine the Service Plan for which you qualify. Except as permitted by the
Agreement, you must maintain service with us on your Term Service Plan for the
minimum term associated with that Term Service Plan. We may offer non-identical
Service Plans to different individuals or entities. Services and coverage under some
Service Plans may be more limited than available under other Service Plans. Your
Service Plan sets out the charges for Services and is your Service Plan until that
Service Plan is changed, you switch to a different Service Plan, or your Services
terminate. Based on your credit rating or other factors, we may require that you
make a deposit, prepayment, or a series of deposits or prepayments, or be subject
to an account spending limit, before Services are activated or maintained.
ChangingServicePlans. If you are on a Non-Term Service Plan, you may change to a
different Service Plan for which you qualify. Any change is effective at the start of
your next full invoicing cycle unless otherwise specified by us at the time that you
place your change order. If you change or add a different Service Plan or service
feature and the change is effective prior to the start of your next full invoicing
cycle, you will be invoiced a prorated amount. We may require a service charge for
implementing any change directed by you in addition to the charges associated
with the Service Plan or optional service features you select. If you are on a Term
Service Plan and you want to change your service plan, you may be required to
accept a new Term Service Plan and we may require you to pay the early
termination fee set out in your Service Plan or other fee.
Termination. Non-TermServicePlan. If you are on a Non-Term Service Plan, you may
terminate Services at any time by giving us notice. Subject to the terms of this
Agreement, we may terminate Services at any time, with or without notice. If your
Service has been suspended due to non-payment, you may be charged a reactivation
fee. We may deactivate any Number before you receive notice of termination
without liability to you. Termination by either of us may be with or without cause.
Termination. TermServicePlan. EXCEPT AS PERMITTED BY THE AGREEMENT, IF
YOU TERMINATE YOUR TERM SERVICE PLAN BEFORE THE END OF THE TERM,
OR IF WE TERMINATE SERVICES FOR CAUSE BEFORE THE END OF THE TERM,
YOU WILL BE REQUIRED TO PAY THE EARLY TERMINATION FEE ASSOCIATED
WITH YOUR TERM SERVICE PLAN. No early termination fee is charged if you
terminate a Term Service Plan in accordance with the return policy associated with
your Term Service Plan. After the expiration of the term, the Terms relating to Non-
Term Service Plans apply.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
252
Termination. General. Regardless of whether you have a Non-Term or a Term
Service Plan, we may terminate or suspend Services to you without liability if: (1)
you breach any provision of this Agreement (including if you fail to pay any charges
for Services); or (2) you fail to pay any charges due us for equipment or otherwise.
If Services are terminated before the end of your current invoicing cycle, we will
not prorate the monthly recurring charge to the date of termination, and you will
not receive a credit or refund for any unused minutes in your Service Plan.
UseofServicesandEquipment;Availability. You must be at least 18 years old to
subscribe to our Services. We may require you to provide proof of your age and
identity. If you are under 18 years old you may be eligible for certain Services that
have Account Spending Limits if a person 18 years or older is also named as a
subscriber on the Account. Your PCS Phone will not accept the services of any
wireless provider other than Sprint (but see Roaming). Services and equipment may
not be used for any unlawful, fraudulent or abusive purpose. By requesting Services,
you agree that you will not use Services and equipment in any unlawful, fraudulent
or abusive manner. You may not resell or lease Services or equipment to anyone.
Coverage. Most services are only available within the operating range of the Sprint
Nationwide PCS Network (also see Roaming). Coverage is not available
everywhere. Coverage and quality of Services may be affected by conditions within
or beyond our control, including network problems, signal strength, your
equipment, and atmospheric, geographic, or topographic conditions. We do not
guarantee service availability or that there will be no interruptions or delays in
Services (e.g., dropped calls, blocked calls, etc.).
Number. We may change the phone number (“Number”) assigned to your
PCS device without compensation by giving you prior notice. You do not own the
Number. You may not modify the Number we program into any phone or other
equipment, duplicate the Number to any device other than that authorized by us
or, except as allowed for by law, transfer (port) the Number to any other individual
or entity. If you transfer the Number to another carrier, the terms of the Agreement
(including the rights and obligations set forth in the Termination paragraphs) still
apply. In certain instances, you may transfer a Number from another carrier to
Sprint. Sprint does not in any way guarantee that such transfers to (or from) Sprint
will be successful. If a transfer to Sprint is not successful, you will be responsible
any discounts provided to you with the purchase of your PCS device. See our
information on Number transfers.
PhoneActivationFee. You may be required to pay a non-refundable phone
activation fee when you activate a new Number, have us switch a Number to a
different phone, have your current Number changed, we activate a different phone
on your existing account or your Service Plan says so.
Charges. For most forms of wireless Service, your usage will be charged from the time
you first initiate contact between your phone or other wireless device and the
network until the network connection is broken, whether or not you are successful
in connecting with the service with which you seek to connect, even if the
connection is later broken or dropped. An exception is that you are not charged for
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
253
voice calls that are not completed. You are charged for completed calls to your
Number from the time shortly before the phone starts ringing until the call is
terminated. You will be charged peak rates for the entire duration of calls initiated
during the peak time periods applicable to your Service. You will be charged off-peak
rates for the entire duration of calls initiated during the off-peak time periods
applicable to your Service. In addition to these usage charges, you may be charged for
recurring monthly service charges, applicable local and long-distance toll charges,
other usage charges, (including voicemail access, call waiting, call forwarding, etc.),
connection fees, roaming charges, directory assistance, call completion charges,
account review and management charges, optional features you select at an extra
cost, surcharges related to government programs, and taxes. Charges for most
Services are incurred in one-minute increments, with partial minutes of use rounded
up to the next highest minute. You must pay, by each invoice due date, all charges for
Services provided to the Number for each phone or other equipment that our
records show you activated, no matter who actually uses or has possession of the
phone or other equipment at the time Services are provided.
PCSVision(ThirdGeneration)Charges. For PCS Vision wireless services, you will be
charged on a per kilobyte basis for data used, rather than for airtime used. As long as
your PCS Vision device is connected to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network
(“PCS Vision network”), you will be incurring data usage charges. You are
responsible for all data activity from and directed to your PCS Phone, regardless of
who initiates the activity. We will invoice you for all data directed to the internet
address (or “IP address”) assigned to your device in a given PCS Vision session,
regardless of whether your device actually receives the data. You will be charged for
data usage initiated by others as well as those you initiate. You will be charged for
additional data used in transporting and routing on the network. You will be charged
for partial and interrupted data downloads or other use, including re-sent data, and
for unsuccessful attempts to reach websites and use other applications and services,
including those resulting from dropped network connections. If you use a Premium
Service (including services provided by third parties but for which you are billed on
your PCS Invoice), you will be charged for data used in transport and routing in
addition to the charge for the Premium Service. The amount of data used and
charged to you will vary widely, depending upon the specific PCS Vision wireless
application or other service you use, the amount of data used in the specific
application or service, and network congestion and other matters. For this and other
reasons, estimates of data usage - for example, the size of downloadable files - will
vary from what you actually use. You cannot receive incoming calls while using
third generation services. Data usage will be rounded up to the next whole kilobyte.
Kilobyte usage will be rounded up to the next full cent. Rounding up will occur at
the end of each separate session or each clock hour (at the top of each hour), if the
session spans more than 1 clock hour. When traveling on our PCS Vision network, a
session may be ended and new session initiated, although no interruption to the
actual data session will occur. Your invoice will not separately identify the number
of kilobytes attributable to your use of specific sites, sessions or services used.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
254
PCSVisionPremiumServices. Your PCS Vision wireless services may allow you to
access or download premium content for an additional charge. Certain PCS Vision
services (e.g., games, ringers and screen savers) primarily contain premium
services content. Access to and downloading of premium content is not included
with PCS Vision services. The additional charges for this premium content will be
billed to you on your PCS Invoice. You will be charged for this content (at rates and
charges specified at the time of access or download) that will be in addition to data
usage charges you will incur while connected to the enhanced PCS Vision network.
We provide no warranties and make no representations or claims with regard to
third-party Premium Services. In certain instances, subject to the terms of the
content purchased, we may delete premium and non-premium items downloaded
to available storage areas (e.g., your vault), including any pictures, games and other
content. We may limit the amount of Premium Services you may purchase in a
specific timeframe (month, week, day, or other time period). We may suspend your
use of Premium Services without prior consent or notice if we have reason to
suspect fraudulent or unauthorized use of your Premium Services account, but we
make no assurances that we will suspend your account.
OtherTermsApplicabletoPCSVisionWirelessUsage. Use of PCS Vision wireless
services requires the purchase of a separate third generation wireless compatible
phone or other device and is subject to any software, memory, storage or other
limitation in the phone or other equipment. Not all applications and services work,
or work the same, on all third generation wireless phones and devices. Check the
materials accompanying your phone or device to determine which applications
and services it will support. PCS Vision wireless services are not available while off
the PCS Vision network. PCS Vision services are not available for server devices or
host computer applications, other systems that drive continuous heavy traffic or
data sessions, or as substitutes for private lines or frame relay connections.
Unlimited PCS Vision plans/options are only available with phones or PCS smart
phones where the device is not being used as a modem in connection with other
equipment (e.g., computers, PDAs, etc.) through use of connection kits or other
phone-to-computer/PDA accessories, or Bluetooth or other wireless technology.
Sprint reserves the right to deny or to terminate service without notice for any
misuse. Sprint is not responsible for any opinions, advice, statements, services
applications or other information provided by third parties and accessible through
PCS Vision wireless services. Neither Sprint nor its vendors or licensors guarantees
the accuracy, completeness or usefulness of information that is obtained through
the PCS Vision wireless services. You are responsible for evaluating such content.
Use of certain PCS Vision wireless services, including some messaging services,
may result in the disclosure to others of your email address and other information
about you in connection with your internet usage. Your accessing of, or use of,
third party sites or services accessible PCS Vision wireless services may require the
disclosure of information about you, subject to the policies of those sites and
services. You consent to receiving advertising, warnings, alerts and other
messages, including broadcast messages. Your access to PCS Vision wireless
services is controlled by a password.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
255
VoiceCommand. PCS Voice Command is an optional service that allows you to
place calls by using speech recognition technology. Calls to 911 or similar
emergency numbers cannot be placed through the Voice Command feature.
Airtime and applicable long distance charges for a call completed from your
Number using the Voice Command feature begin when you press or activate the
TALK or similar key(s) and end when your call is terminated by hitting the END key
or by returning to the Voice Command platform. If you initiate and complete
another call without leaving the Voice Command platform, a separate charge for
that call will begin from the time the previous call was terminated. Airtime and
applicable long distance charges will be applied to the entire length of a completed
call initiated from Voice Command. Using Directory Assistance to input names into
your Voice Command address book will incur additional charges.
Invoicing. Invoicing cycles are approximately 30 days in length. Invoicing cycles
and dates may change from time to time. Except as otherwise provided in your
Service Plan, monthly recurring charges (MRCs) are invoiced one invoicing cycle in
advance. Charges for Services are usually invoiced as soon as possible after the
charges accrue. We may, however, invoice you for usage and charges occurring
before the invoicing cycle being invoiced, if they were not previously invoiced. If
you are invoiced for usage incurred during a prior invoicing cycle, those minutes
will be applied to your Service Plan minutes for the current invoicing cycle.
However, if you change your PCS Service Plan between the time the usage was
incurred and the beginning of the current invoicing cycle, those minutes from the
prior invoicing cycle will be charged at the rate per minute for usage over included
minutes provided in the Service Plan in effect at the time the usage was incurred.
Payment. If you have authorized payment for Services or equipment by credit card
or by debiting a bank account, no additional notice or consent is required before we
invoice the credit card or debit the bank account for all amounts due to us or billed
by us on behalf of a third party. You must promptly notify us of any change in your
invoicing address or of the credit card or bank account used for payment. We
reserve the right to require payment by money order, cashier’s check or other
secured form of payment. If we take action to receive payment beyond invoicing
you for charges for Services or equipment, you must pay our costs and expenses of
collection, including attorneys’ fees and expenses, the fees of any collection agency
and court costs. If we act as an invoicing agent for a third-party service provider,
payments received are first applied to amounts due and owing to us and any
remaining amounts are applied to sums due and owing to the third-party service
provider. We may immediately charge an additional fee for any check or other
negotiable instrument endorsed by you and returned unpaid by a financial
institution for any reason. You may be charged fees for certain methods of payment.
LatePaymentCharges. Payment is past due if we do not receive it by the due date
shown on your invoice. Any payment for Services and equipment not made when
due accrues late charges until paid at the rate of 5% per month or at the highest rate
allowed by law. Acceptance of late or partial payments (even if marked “paid in full”)
does not waive our right to collect all amounts that you owe us. If your Service has
been suspended due to non-payment, you may be charged a reactivation fee.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
256
DisputedCharges. You must raise any dispute that you have about any charges
invoiced to you within 15 days of the date of the invoice or you have accepted the
invoice. You may notify us of any dispute by notifying PCS Customer Service
Solutions. Calls to our sales or general business offices are not notice of a dispute. If
disputed invoice procedures are described on the invoice, you must follow them.
AccountSpendingLimit. If we agree to provide Services to you on an Account
Spending Limit basis, we will tell you your Account Spending Limit before we start
Services to your Number, or as reasonably practicable after the limit is imposed. If
we require a deposit for you to establish or keep Services on an Account Spending
Limit basis, we will hold the deposit as partial guarantee of payment for Services (see
Deposits). Charges for Services accrue against your Account Spending Limit as they
are incurred. We may charge an initial ASL start up fee. We may charge a monthly ASL
service fee, in addition to your recurring monthly service charge. We may suspend
Services to your Number without prior notice to you when your account balance
reaches your Account Spending Limit. Services are restored when you have paid any
past due balance and pay a specified minimum amount to reduce your account
balance below your Account Spending Limit. We may change this minimum amount
at any time upon notice to you. You may pay any past due balance and the minimum
amount by any method authorized by Sprint. Contact PCS Customer Service
Solutions for information about authorized methods of making these payments. We
may charge you a fee for calls that involve our live customer care services. If we
provide Services to you on an Account Spending Limit basis, Services and coverage
may be limited in certain ways. You must pay all charges for Services even if they
exceed the amount of your Account Spending Limit.
ClearPay. If we agree to provide Services to you as a Clear Pay customer, we may
suspend Services to your Number without prior notice to you immediately when
your bill becomes past due. Even if your bill is not past due, we may suspend
services if your unpaid usage exceeds $125 or another amount to be determined by
your past credit or usage history. If we require a deposit for you to establish or keep
Services as a Clear Pay customer, we will hold the deposit as partial guarantee of
payment for Services (see Deposits, below). Contact PCS Customer Service
Solutions for information about authorized methods of making these payments. We
may charge you a fee for calls that involve our live customer care services. If we
provide Services to you on as a Clear Pay basis, Services and coverage may be
limited in certain ways. You must pay all charges for Services whether or not your
Services are suspended or terminated.
Deposits. If we require a deposit for you to establish or keep Services, we will hold
the deposit as partial guarantee of payment for Services. We may change the
deposit amount at any time to reflect revised estimated monthly charges based
upon your usage. A deposit may not be used to pay any invoice (unless it is used to
pay a final invoice) or delay payment. The deposit amount, the length of time we
hold the deposit and changes to the deposit amount are determined based on your
credit and payment history. The rate of interest, if any, on the deposit is subject to
change. We may mix deposits with our other funds. If Services are terminated for
any reason, we may, without notice to you, apply your deposit toward payment of
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
257
outstanding charges and return any excess to you at your last known address within
75 days after termination of Services. If the U.S. Postal Service cannot deliver the
money to you and returns it to us, we will hold it for you for one year from the date
of return and, during that period, we may charge a servicing fee against the deposit
balance. Any money held during this one-year period will not accrue interest for
your benefit. You forfeit any portion of the money left after the one-year period.
WirelessWebandVoicePortalServices. Wireless Web Services are part of the
Services that can be obtained through Sprint. Wireless Web Services are not
available in all markets or while roaming off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network.
Use of Wireless Web Services requires an Internet-ready PCS Phone or certain other
equipment (or both) and is subject to any memory, storage or other limitation in the
phone or other equipment. Wireless Web Services are not available on PCS Vision
phones or devices. The Caller ID blocking feature is not available when using
Wireless Web Services. Any use of Wireless Web Services deducts from your Service
Plan minutes. For data calls (including Wireless Web and Voice Portal calls) that are
attempted, but not completed, you are charged for the time during which the
network attempts to connect the call. You are charged for time spent connected to
the Wireless Web or Voice Portal, including time spent browsing on the Internet or
Voice Portal and reviewing or scrolling through Internet information on-line while
still connected to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. Not all Internet sites can be
accessed and you may receive an error message if you attempt to access a site that
cannot be accessed through Wireless Web Services. You are also charged for
Wireless Web connections to review your PCS account information. Wireless Web
Services are not available with all Service Plans. Sprint is not responsible for any
opinions, advice, statements, services or other information provided by third-
parties and accessible through Wireless Web Services or Voice Portal Services.
Neither Sprint nor its vendors or licensors guarantees the accuracy, completeness or
usefulness of information that is obtained through the Wireless Web Services or
Voice Portal Services. You are responsible for evaluating such content.
TaxesandSurcharges. We invoice you for taxes, fees and other charges levied by or
remitted directly to federal, state or local authorities, or foreign government on
Services including, without limitation, sales, gross receipts, use, and excise taxes. If
you claim any tax exemption, you must provide us with a valid tax-exempt
document. Any tax exemption applies only from the date we receive a valid tax-
exempt document. We also invoice you for fees that we collect and remit to the
government such as Universal Service, and for surcharges that we collect and keep
to pay for the costs of complying with government mandates such as number
pooling and portability, and Enhanced 911 service. These charges are neither taxes
nor government imposed assessments.
Roaming. Calls made while off the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network are “roaming”
calls. Your PCS Phone is specifically designed and engineered to work only on the
Sprint Nationwide PCS Network. It works on another CDMA PCS provider’s system
only when a roaming agreement is in place between Sprint and the other providers.
If your PCS Phone is a dual-mode phone, it works on both a CDMA PCS provider’s
system (in addition to the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network) and a wireless analog
telecommunications provider’s system only when roaming agreements are in place
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
258
between Sprint and the other providers. If we do not have a roaming agreement in
place, you may be able to place roaming calls “manually” by using a valid credit card.
If there is a gap or other interruption of coverage within a PCS coverage area that
prevents connection with the Sprint Nationwide PCS Network and your dual-band
phone is set to roam automatically when outside PCS coverage, you may incur
roaming fees within a PCS coverage area. Certain features and services may not be
available when roaming (including PCS Vision, voicemail, call waiting, call
forwarding, etc.).
PhonesandOtherEquipment. Phones and other equipment may be purchased and
returned as provided in the purchase documents. We are not the manufacturer of
the phones or other equipment. The only warranties on the phones or other
equipment are any limited warranties extended by the manufacturers. We have no
liability in connection with the phones and other equipment or for the
manufacturers’ acts or omissions.
LostorStolenEquipment. If your phone or other equipment is lost or stolen, you
must notify us by calling PCS Customer Service Solutions. You are responsible for
all charges for Services provided to the Number for the lost or stolen equipment
before you notify us of the loss or theft. We will deactivate Services to the Number
upon notification to us of any loss or theft. You may be required to provide
evidence of the loss or theft (for example, a police report or sworn statement). If
the equipment is later found, we may require that you exchange it for another
phone or other equipment before we reactivate Services (if we do reactivate
Services), as well as require you to pay a reactivation fee. We will deactivate
Services to any Number without prior notice to you if we suspect any unlawful or
fraudulent use of the Number. You agree to cooperate reasonably with us in
investigating suspected unlawful or fraudulent use.
Messages. You will incur airtime usage charges when accessing your voicemail
from your PCS Phone. You may also incur charges in accessing text messages from
your PCS Phone. You may access your voicemail without incurring airtime usage
charges by checking your voicemail from a wireline phone. We may impose limits
on the number of voicemail or text message that can be retained through your
PCS account. Audible or visual indicators of text or voicemail messages, including
mailbox icons on your PCS Phone, may not always provide an up to date indication
of new messages. In certain instances, you may be required to manually reset or
clear your mailbox indicator.
CallerID. If you do not want people you call to receive the Number assigned to your
phone, you must call PCS Customer Service Solutions for information about
automatic Caller ID blocking. The Number assigned to your phone can be blocked
on a per-call basis by dialing *67 + Destination Number + TALK (or similar key), but
Caller ID delivery resumes on the next call you make. Caller ID display on incoming
calls to your Number depends on receiving the information from the calling party.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
259
TTYAccess. A TTY (also known as TDD or Text Telephone) is a telecommunications
device that allows people who are deaf or hard of hearing, or who have speech or
language disabilities, to communicate by telephone. TTY doesn’t work with all
PCS Phones. If you have a PCS TTY-capable phone, it may not function effectively, or
at all, when attempting 911 calls due to the equipment or software of the answering
agency. Therefore, a TTY device should not be relied on for 911 calls.
Pay-Per-CallService. We will not complete calls from your Number to 900, 976 and
similar numbers for pay-per-call services.
InternationalCalling. You may be limited in the international destinations that you
can call with Services. You should contact PCS Customer Service Solutions for
information about international destinations that you cannot call.
LimitationofLiability. Except as otherwise provided in this section, our sole liability
to you for any loss or damage arising out of providing or failing to provide Services
(including mistakes, omissions, interruptions, delays, errors, or defects) does not
exceed (1) in cases related to a specific piece of equipment, the prorated MRC for
Services to the piece of equipment during the affected period, or (2) in cases not
related to a specific piece of equipment, the prorated MRCs for Services to you
during the affected period. Neither we nor our vendors, suppliers or licensors are
liable for any damage arising out of or in connection with:
a) any act or omission of any telecommunications service or other service
provider other than us;
b) any directory listing;
c) any dropped calls or inability to place or receive calls;
d) any interruption of Services, including interruptions caused by equipment or
facilities failure or shortages, transmission limitations or system capacity
limitations;
e) traffic or other accidents, or any health-related claims allegedly arising from the
use of Services, phones, equipment or accessories used in connection with the
Services;
f) the use of Wireless Web Services and PCS Vision applications and services,
including the accuracy or reliability of any information obtained from the Internet
using Wireless Web Services or from Voice Portal Services, PCS Vision wireless
services or Internet services, content or applications not supported by Sprint PCS;
g) any late or failed message delivery;
h) any interruption or failure of 911 or E911 emergency services or identification
of the Number, address or name associated with any person accessing or
attempting to access emergency services from your phone;
i) the installation or repair of any products or equipment by parties who are not
our authorized employees or agents;
j) events due to factors beyond our control, including acts of God (including,
without limitation, weather-related phenomena, fire or earthquake), war, riot,
strike, or orders of governmental authority;
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
260
k) any act or omission of any third party or independent contractor that offers
products or services in conjunction with or through the Services; or
l) your negligent or intentional act or omission.
NOCONSEQUENTIALOROTHERDAMAGES. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES ARE WE
LIABLE FOR ANY INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR SPECIAL
DAMAGES OF ANY NATURE WHATSOEVER ARISING OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH PROVIDING OR FAILING TO PROVIDE SERVICES, PHONES
OR OTHER EQUIPMENT USED IN CONNECTION WITH THE SERVICES,
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS, LOSS OF BUSINESS, OR
COST OF REPLACEMENT PRODUCTS AND SERVICES. THIS SECTION SURVIVES
TERMINATION OF THIS AGREEMENT.
Indemnification. You indemnify and defend us, our partners, directors, officers,
employees and agents from and against any claim, action, damage, liability and
expense arising out of or in connection with: (1) your acts or omissions that occur
in connection with your use of the Services or equipment used in connection with
the Services, and (2) any communications you make or receive using the Services.
This indemnification extends to and includes any attorney’s fees and costs incurred
by us arising from any actions or claims to which this indemnification applies, or
from the contesting of the applicability of this provision. This section survives
termination of this Agreement.
MANDATORYARBITRATIONOFDISPUTES. ANY CLAIM, CONTROVERSY OR
DISPUTE OF ANY KIND BETWEEN THE CUSTOMER AND THE COMPANY AND/OR
ANY OF ITS EMPLOYEES, AGENTS, AFFILIATES OR OTHER REPRESENTATIVES,
WHETHER SOUNDING IN CONTRACT, STATUTE, OR TORT, INCLUDING FRAUD,
MISREPRESENTATION, FRAUDULENT INDUCEMENT, OR ANY OTHER LEGAL OR
EQUITABLE THEORY AND REGARDLESS OF THE DATE OF ACCRUAL OF SUCH
CLAIM, CONTROVERSY OR DISPUTE SHALL BE RESOLVED BY FINAL AND
BINDING ARBITRATION AS PRESCRIBED IN THIS SECTION. THE FEDERAL
ARBITRATION ACT, NOT STATE LAW, GOVERNS THE QUESTION OF WHETHER A
CLAIM IS SUBJECT TO ARBITRATION. HOWEVER, NOTHING CONTAINED IN
THIS ARBITRATION PROVISION SHALL PRECLUDE THE CUSTOMER FROM
RESOLVING ANY CLAIM, CONTROVERSY OR DISPUTE IN SMALL CLAIMS COURT
HE OR SHE OTHERWISE WOULD HAVE THE RIGHT TO PURSUE.
A single arbitrator engaged in the practice of law will conduct the arbitration. The
arbitrator will be selected according to the rules of CPR or, alternatively, may be
selected by agreement of the parties, who shall cooperate in good faith to select the
arbitrator. The arbitration will be conducted by, and under the then-applicable
rules of the CPR Institute for Dispute Resolution. All expedited procedures
prescribed by the applicable rules will apply. Any required hearing fees and costs
shall be paid by the parties as required by the applicable rules or as required by
applicable law, but the arbitrator shall have the power to apportion such costs as
the arbitrator deems appropriate.The arbitrator’s decision and award will be final
and binding (subject to the appeal clause below), and judgment on the award
rendered by the arbitrator may be entered in any court with jurisdiction.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
261
An appeal may be taken under the CPR Arbitration Appeal Procedure from any final
award of any arbitral panel in any arbitration arising out of or related to this
agreement that is conducted in accordance with the requirements of such Appeal
Procedure. Unless otherwise agreed by the parties and the appeal tribunal, the
appeal shall be conducted at the place of the original arbitration.
If any party files a judicial or administrative action asserting a claim that is subject to
arbitration and another party successfully stays such action or compels arbitration,
the party filing that action must pay the other party’s costs and expenses incurred
in seeking such stay or compelling arbitration, including attorney’s fees.
Notices. You may get our current address for written notice by calling PCS Customer
Service Solutions. Written notice to you is sent to your last known address in our
invoicing records. Written notice is effective three days after deposit in the U.S.
mail, postage prepaid, and properly addressed. Unless required by this Agreement
or Applicable Laws, (1) you may notify us by calling PCS Customer Service Solutions,
and (2) we may notify you by leaving a message for you on your PCS Phone,
answering machine or with your answering service. Notice addresses may be
changed by giving notice as provided in this section.
ChoiceofLaw;Jurisdiction. This Agreement is governed by and must be construed
under federal law and the laws of the State of Kansas, without regard to choice of
law principles.
General. If either of us does not enforce any right or remedy available under this
Agreement, that failure is not a waiver of the right or remedy for any other breach or
failure by the other party. Our waiver of any requirement in any one instance is not a
general waiver of that requirement and does not amend this Agreement. This
Agreement is subject to any applicable federal and state law (collectively,
“Applicable Laws”). If any part of this Agreement is held invalid or unenforceable,
that part is interpreted consistent with Applicable Laws as nearly as possible to
reflect the original intentions of the parties and the rest of this Agreement remains in
full force and effect. Section headings are for descriptive purposes only and are not
used to interpret this Agreement. You may not assign this Agreement to any other
person or entity without our prior written approval. This Agreement (including any
referenced documents and attachments) makes up the entire agreement between
you and us and replaces all prior written or spoken agreements, representations,
promises or understandings between you and us. The provisions of this Agreement
that are contemplated to be enforceable after the termination of this Agreement
survive termination of this Agreement. If there is a conflict, the Service Plan
(including any Term Service Plan) controls over the Terms.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
262
TermsofPictureMailService
The Picture Mail service (“Service”) – including access to and use of the services at
www.picturemail.sprintpcs.com – is provided to you by Sprint under the following
terms and conditions and incorporate the Terms and Conditions set forth at
www.sprintpcs.com which include the Terms and Conditions of Service provided
with your PCS Phone User’s Guide, terms regarding copyright and trademark
matters, and other terms relating to the use of our services. Your use of the Service
indicates your acceptance of all of these terms (collectively “Terms”). Sprint may
change these Terms from time to time at our discretion with or without notice to
you. Any changes will be posted on the Service.
1. Eligibility
The Service is provided to individuals who are at least 18 years old and to minors
who have parental permission. We encourage parents and guardians to take an
active role in protecting the privacy and security of their children. If you as a parent
have any concerns regarding this issue, please feel free to contact us at
2. MembershipFees
Picture Mail is available at an additional monthly charge (in addition to any charges
you may pay for PCS Vision services) through Sprint and provides you basic
services, such as the ability to store and share pictures taken on select PCS Vision
Picture Phones or devices. Additional features or services (beyond basic services)
may also be available from time to time for an additional charge. If you have
previously not signed up for the Service with activation of your PCS Service Plan,
you may add this Service to your account for an additional monthly charge through
a PCS Vision Picture Phone.
3. PictureMailPassword
We will have access to your Picture Mail Password and User Name. We may remind
you of your password, at your request, by sending an email to the address you used
when creating your account. We will not disclose your Picture Mail Password to
third parties, but we may access your account if necessary to maintain the Service,
to comply with lawful requests from governmental authorities, or in response to
court orders, subpoenas, complaints.
4. PhotoLoss
Sprint does not warrant that pictures or albums stored will not be deleted,
modified or damaged. If pictures or images are particularly valuable, have
sentimental or other intangible value or are otherwise unique or irreplaceable,
reliable storage alternatives should be used, including hard copy duplication and
electronic back up and storage.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
263
5. UseofRelatedSoftware
Any software that is provided for download and installation on your personal
computer or electronic device in connection with the Service is licensed under the
terms and conditions of a separate software license agreement. These license
agreements are available for your review upon download, installation and/or use of
that software.
6. UseofPictureMail
Solely for the purposes of displaying your pictures to selected persons and fulfilling
your print orders, you grant us permission to use, download, upload, copy, print,
display, reproduce, modify, publish, post, transmit and distribute any material
included in your albums.
7. MemberConduct
(a) In consideration for use of the Service, you agree to provide true, accurate,
current and complete information about you as prompted during the registration
process, and to maintain and update this information to keep it true, accurate,
current and complete.
(b) You are responsible for maintaining the confidentiality of your Picture Mail
Password and Account, and you agree to be fully responsible for all activities which
occur through anyone’s use of your Picture Mail Password or account, whether or
not authorized by you. You agree to notify Sprint immediately of any unauthorized
use of your password or account or any other breach of security.
(c) You must provide at your own expense all equipment and software required to
use the Service, including computer and photography equipment, application
software, modems, and access to the Internet. We are not responsible for delays
resulting from incompatibility of such equipment and software, or from improper
configuration or maintenance of such equipment and software.
(d) While we do not control the content of any member submissions to the Service
and do not have any obligation to monitor such content, if we have any reason to
believe that any language, content, graphics or other materials contained within
your content is inappropriate, we may, in our sole discretion, refuse to process any
print orders, remove your pictures from our servers, suspend your account, restrict
access to it, remove content from it, or terminate it.
(e) You agree (1) not to use the Service for illegal purposes; (2) not to interfere with
or disrupt the Service or servers or networks or software or data connected to the
Service; (3) to comply with all requirements, procedures, policies and regulations of
networks connected to the Service; and (4) to comply with all applicable laws
regarding the transmission of technical data exported from the United States. You
agree to abide by all applicable local, state, national, and international laws and
regulations in your use of the Service and in your use of any software downloaded
from the Service, including, without limitation, copyright, trademark, obscenity and
defamation laws.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
264
(f) You agree not to interfere with the use and enjoyment of the Service by other
users of the Service. You agree not to attempt to gain unauthorized access to other
computer systems or networks connected to the Service.
(g) You agree not to transmit through the Service, or upload to it (1) any pictures or
other content in violation of the copyrights, privacy rights or other rights of any
other person; (2) any unlawful, harassing, libelous, privacy invading, abusive,
hateful, threatening, harmful, vulgar, defamatory, obscene or otherwise
objectionable material of any kind; (3) any material that violates the rights of
another, including, but not limited to, the intellectual property rights of another;
(4) any material that harms minors; (5) any material that violates any applicable
local, state, national, or international law or regulation; or (6) “junk mail,” “spam,”
“chain letters,” or unsolicited mass distribution of email.
8. PrivacyStatement
In order to register you as a member of the Service, we ask you to supply us with
some basic information (email address, user selected Picture Mail Password, name)
during the registration process and, occasionally, at other times while using the
Service. All uses of your information will be in accordance with our privacy policy,
as set forth in the following Privacy Policy. As this policy may be updated from time
PRIVACYPOLICY
(a) Sprint respects the privacy of its customers, and other individuals and
businesses using the Websites owned and operated by Sprint and its Affiliates
(“Sprint Websites”). This updated Privacy Policy effective October 22, 2001, is to
keep you informed about the types of information collected on Sprint Websites and
how the information is used and protected. The revised Privacy Policy includes
information about advertisements on Sprint Websites and access to your account
information.
Sprint protects the privacy of its local, long distance and wireless customers
consistent with the Federal Telecommunications Act and rules and regulations
issued by the Federal Communications Commission.
Sprint’s Privacy Policy for its high speed Internet services can be accessed at:
There are two types of information that may be exchanged between the Sprint site
and the user during each visit to a Sprint site. They are:
1. General technical data transmitted between your computer and the Sprint site
that does not identify you personally.
2. Personally identifiable information that you voluntarily share. The types of
personally identifiable information that you might share include your name,
address, phone number, email address and credit card number.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
265
(b)AnonymousInformation
In order to provide you with the information and services that you look for from the
Sprint Websites, Sprint gathers certain types of information from you that are not
personally identifiable. This is called anonymous information and includes:
1. The type of Internet browser you use when you visit
2. The types of computer operating system you use
The anonymous information collected is not associated with you personally or
your business. Sprint uses this anonymous information in the aggregate to improve
Sprint Websites and the services we provide through those sites.
(c)UseOfCookies
Sprint Websites may use “cookies” to collect the anonymous information described
in this Privacy Policy. Cookies are bits of encrypted data that are loaded by a Sprint
server onto your computer or other device when you visit a Sprint Website. The
server can retrieve the cookies the next time you visit a site and use them to identify
the computer as a return visitor. Sprint uses cookies to collect non-personally
identifiable information and generically track usage patterns on the Sprint Websites
in order to monitor activity and administer the sites. Sprint also uses information
obtained from cookies to improve Sprint Websites, and make decisions concerning
advertising, product offerings and services. Most users can disable cookies from
their Internet browsers, receive a warning before a cookie is placed on their
computer, and erase all cookies from their computer hard drives by following the
instructions provided by the browser.
(d)AdvertisementsOnSprintWebsites
Advertising companies deliver ads on some Sprint Websites. You should be aware
that when you click on these ads, the advertising companies may also deploy
cookies to receive anonymous information about ad viewing by Internet users on
Sprint Websites and other Websites. This information is associated with your Web
browser, but cannot be associated with your name or email address without your
permission. Therefore, advertising companies may know where your computer
goes on the Web, but they do not know who you are unless you tell them. Sprint
does not provide personally identifiable information about its customers or Sprint
Website visitors to these advertising companies.
(e)PersonallyIdentifiableInformation
Sprint may ask you to provide what is often referred to as “personally identifiable
information” such as your name, address, telephone number and email address
when you use Sprint Websites to: purchase a service or product online, enter a
contest or sweepstakes, ask to receive information, respond to a survey, register
with a Sprint Website, access your account, ask for a personalized service, request
customer service online, or apply for a job. You always have the alternative of
mailing or calling Sprint with the information requested if you do not wish to
provide it online. Personally identifiable information provided at a Sprint Website
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
266
to order Sprint services other than Internet services will be protected in the same
manner as when the information is provided by other means such as over the
telephone or by mail. We protect customer information obtained from the local,
long distance and wireless service customers of Sprint consistent with federal laws
governing telecommunications services and with regulations issued by the Federal
Communications Commission. Sprint’s Privacy Policy for its Internet services can
We use personally identifiable information provided at a Sprint Website in the
following ways unless otherwise specified:
1. For its intended purpose (such as to complete an online order for service).
2. To provide you with information about new PCS Products and Services or
products and services offered in conjunction with Sprint business partners.
(f)DisclosureToThirdParties
Sprint will not sell or disclose to outside parties any personally identifiable
information obtained from a Sprint online service or the registration at a Sprint
Website without your consent except under the following circumstances:
1. When required by law,
2. When disclosure is necessary to protect the safety of a customer, third party or
Sprint’s property,
3. If it is required in connection with any sale or transfer of all or a portion of
Sprint’s assets.
When Sprint uses agents, contractors or other companies to perform services on
its behalf, Sprint will require that they protect your personally identifiable
information consistent with this Privacy Policy. Sprint may share the anonymous
information described in this Privacy Policy with third parties from time-to-time.
(g)EmailCommunications
Email is an increasingly popular communication tool through which you and your
business may communicate with Sprint. Likewise, Sprint may use email to
communicate with you, respond to your email, and to tell you about new products
and services. If you do not wish to receive email promotions and new products and
service announcements from Sprint, please follow the instructions that appear at
the end of the email communication that you receive from Sprint to have your
name removed from the list.
(h)Security
Sprint utilizes several encryption methods to ensure that the data you submit on
any of the Sprint Websites is secure. Through this “secure session,” information
that you input into a Sprint online order form will be sent and will arrive privately
and unaltered at a Sprint server. This security prohibits access to your information
by other companies and Web users.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
267
(i)Children
Sprint does not intend to collect personally identifiable information from
individuals under 18 years of age. If Sprint becomes aware that a user who is under
18 is using a Sprint Website, Sprint will specifically instruct that individual that they
are not to submit information on Sprint Websites without a parent or guardian’s
consent. If a child has provided Sprint with personally identifiable information
without the knowledge of Sprint, a parent or guardian of the child may contact
our existing files.
(j)Links
Some Sprint Websites contain links to other Websites that are owned and operated
by parties other than Sprint. Please be aware that this Privacy Policy does not
extend to any Websites other than those owned and controlled by Sprint.
(k)AccountInformation
verify your name, address, email address, telephone number and/or billing
information. Sprint will correct any information that is inaccurate.
(l)Questions
If you have questions or comments regarding this Privacy Policy, you may contact
information, and would like that information deleted from our records, please
efforts to delete that information from our files.
(m)Updates
Sprint may amend this Privacy Policy from time-to- time. These changes will be
posted online.
9. UsageandStorage
We and our suppliers assume no responsibility for: (1) any full or partial loss,
deletion or failure to store your pictures or any other data; (2) any notice or lack of
notice of such loss, deletion or failure to store your data; or (3) any correct or
erroneous informing of or failure to inform user of such loss, deletion or failure to
store your data. From time to time we may establish an upper limit on the size of
data storage that you are permitted to use on the Service and/or an upper limit on
the frequency or amount of usage that you are permitted on the Service or related
software. We may establish a reasonable period of time (for example, three
months) such that if you do not use the Service at least once during such period, we
may terminate the Service to you for non-use, and delete pictures and other data
that you may have stored through the Service.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
268
10. NoResaleofServiceorSoftware
Your membership account is intended only for personal, noncommercial use. You
agree not to reproduce, duplicate, copy, sell, resell or exploit for any commercial
purposes, any portion of the Service, use of the Service, access to the Service, or
related software.
11. ProprietaryRights
You agree that content, including but not limited to software, text, pictures,
graphics, video, music, sound, or other materials or information, contained in the
Service or contained in sponsor advertisements or presented to you through the
Service or advertisers is protected by copyrights, trademarks, service marks,
patents, or other proprietary rights, laws, and/or treaties. You agree that you are
permitted to use such materials and information only as expressly authorized by us
or the true owner of the right in question and you may not copy, reproduce,
transmit, distribute, or create derivative works of such materials or information
without proper express, written authorization from us or the true owner of the
right in question.
12. ChangestotheServiceandTerminationoftheService
(a) We may change these Terms from time to time without notice to you. Should
you object to any of these Terms or any changes to them, or should you become
dissatisfied with the Service in any way, your only recourse is to immediately: (1)
discontinue use of the Service; and (2) terminate the Service and notify us of the
termination. Termination of the Service may, in some instances, require you to
change your PCS Service Plan.
(b) We may discontinue the Service or any feature or portion of the Service at any
time, with or without notice. You agree that upon modification or discontinuance
of the Service, we may delete the data you have stored on the Service.
(c) You agree that we may terminate your membership in the Service and delete any
and all information, posting, communications, albums and pictures at any time,
without notice, if we believe: (1) that you have failed to use the Service at least
once during a reasonable span of time as determined by us; (2) that you have
violated or acted inconsistently with the letter or spirit of these Terms; (3) that you
have violated our rights or the rights of other users or parties; or (4) that you have
abused or misused the Service in any way, including but not limited to exceeding
any limits that we may place on the amount of data that any individual may store on
the Service.
(d) We reserve the right at all times to disclose any information posted by you or any
other user as necessary to satisfy any law, regulation or governmental request, or to
edit, remove, or refuse to post any information or materials, in whole or in part,
that in our sole discretion are objectionable or in violation of these terms and
conditions.
(e) Except as otherwise set forth in this provision, in the event your Service is
terminated we will make reasonable efforts to provide 30 days prior notice before
may delete any data from the Service.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
269
13. Disclaimers
(a) We hereby disclaim any and all responsibility or liability for the accuracy,
content, completeness, legality, reliability, operability or availability of information
or material in this Service. We further disclaim any responsibility for the deletion,
misdelivery, failure to store or untimely delivery of any information or material. We
disclaim any responsibility for any harm resulting from downloading or accessing
any information or material through the Service. You agree that you, the member,
will bear all risk associated with any content that you access.
(b) All processing of film, prints, slides, negatives or digital images is subject to our
Terms. You agree that your sole remedy for any damage or loss of any materials that
you submit to us for processing, printing, storage, transmission or other handling,
even if caused by negligence or other fault, will only entitle you to replacement
with a like amount of unexposed film and processing. EXCEPT FOR THE
EXCLUSIVE REMEDY OF REPLACEMENT, THE HANDLING OF ANY FILM, PRINT,
SLIDE, NEGATIVE OR DIGITAL IMAGE IS WITHOUT WARRANTY OR LIABILITY
AND RECOVERY FOR ANY INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES IS
EXCLUDED.
(c) THIS SITE AND ALL PRODUCTS, SERVICES AND CONTENT PROVIDED
THROUGH IT ARE PROVIDED “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE” AND WITH NO
WARRANTIES WHATSOEVER. TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW, WE EXPRESSLY DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND,
WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. WE DISCLAIM ANY WARRANTIES FOR THE
SECURITY, RELIABILITY, TIMELINESS, AND PERFORMANCE OF THIS SERVICE,
OR THAT THIS SITE OR OUR SERVER IS FREE OF VIRUSES OR OTHER HARMFUL
COMPONENTS. WE DISCLAIM, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY LAW,
ANY WARRANTIES FOR OTHER SERVICES OR GOODS RECEIVED THROUGH OR
ADVERTISED ON THIS SERVICE OR RECEIVED THROUGH ANY LINKS PROVIDED
IN THE SERVICE, AS WELL AS FOR ANY INFORMATION OR ADVICE RECEIVED
THROUGH THE SERVICE OR THROUGH ANY LINKS PROVIDED IN THE SERVICE.
(d) YOU EXPRESSLY AGREE THAT, TO THE MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW, UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL SPRINT BE LIABLE TO
ANY USER ON ACCOUNT OF THAT USER’S USE OR MISUSE OF AND RELIANCE
ON THE SITE OR ITS ASSOCIATED PRODUCTS AND SERVICES. SUCH
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL APPLY TO PREVENT RECOVERY OF DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, AND
PUNITIVE DAMAGES (EVEN IF WE HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES). SUCH LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL APPLY WHETHER
THE DAMAGES ARISE FROM USE OR MISUSE OF AND RELIANCE ON THE SITE,
PRODUCTS OR SERVICES, FROM INABILITY TO USE THE SITE OR FROM THE
INTERRUPTION, SUSPENSION, OR TERMINATION OF THE SITE OR DAMAGES
INCURRED BY REASON OF OTHER SERVICES OR GOODS RECEIVED THROUGH
OR ADVERTISED ON THIS SERVICE OR RECEIVED THROUGH ANY LINKS
PROVIDED ON THIS SITE, AS WELL AS BY REASON OF ANY INFORMATION OR
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
270
ADVICE RECEIVED THROUGH OR ADVERTISED ON THE SERVICES OR RECEIVED
THROUGH ANY LINKS PROVIDED IN THE PRODUCTS AND SERVICES.
(e) BECAUSE SOME JURISDICTIONS PROHIBIT THE EXCLUSION OF CERTAIN
WARRANTIES OR THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF LIABILITY FOR
CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, THE ABOVE LIMITATION MAY
NOT APPLY TO YOU. OUR OWN AND OUR SUPPLIERS’ TOTAL LIABILITY FOR
DAMAGES, LOSSES, AND CAUSES OF ACTION, REGARDLESS OF LEGAL THEORY,
WILL IN NO EVENT EXCEED THE AGGREGATE DOLLAR AMOUNT YOU HAVE
PAID TO US UNDER THESE TERMS, OR US $25.00, WHICHEVER IS GREATER.
14. Indemnity
You agree to indemnify and hold Sprint and its parents, suppliers, licensors,
subsidiaries, affiliates, officers, and employees harmless from any claim or demand,
including reasonable attorneys’ fees, made by any third party due to or arising out
of: (1) use of the Service by you or by anyone using your account; (2) violation of
these Terms by you or by anyone using your account; or (3) violation or
infringement by you, or by anyone using your account, of intellectual property
rights or any other rights of any other person.
15. GeneralProvisions
We may assign our rights and duties under these Terms to any third party at any
time without notice to you. These Terms and the relationship between you and
Sprint shall be governed by the laws of the State of California without regard to its
conflict of law provisions. You and Sprint agree to submit to the personal and
exclusive jurisdiction of the courts located within the State of California. You agree
that regardless of any statute or law to the contrary, any claim or cause of action
arising out of or related to use of the Service must be filed within one (1) year after
such claim or cause of action arose or be forever barred. The failure of Sprint to
exercise or enforce any right or provision of these Terms shall not constitute a
waiver of such right or provision.
If any provision of these Terms is found by a court of competent jurisdiction to be
invalid, the parties nevertheless agree that the court should endeavor to give effect
to the parties’ intentions as reflected in the provision, and that the other provisions
of the Terms shall be valid and remain in full force and effect.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
271
Manufacturer’s Warranty
CustomerLimitedWarranty
SPRINT SPECTRUM, L.P., (Sprint) offers you a limited warranty that the enclosed
subscriber unit (Product), including accessories in the product package, will be
free from defects in material or workmanship as follows:
SUBSCRIBER UNIT:
A. SPRINT ONE (1) YEAR LIMITED WARRANTY: For a period of one (1) year from
the date of purchase, Sprint will, at its option, either pay the parts and labor charges
®
to any authorized PCS Phone service facility to repair or replace a defective
product (with new or rebuilt parts/replacements). After this one (1) year period,
you must pay all parts, shipping and labor charges.
B. REPAIRS: For a period equal to the remainder of the original limited warranty
period on an original Product or for the 180 days after the date of
repair/replacement, whichever is longer, Sprint will repair or replace (with new or
rebuilt replacement) defective parts or Product used in the repair or replacement
of the original Product under this Limited Warranty.
Proof of purchase in the from of a bill of sale or receipted invoice warranty repair
document which is evidence that the Product is within the warranty period must
be presented to obtain warranty service. This limited warranty is not transferable
to any third party, including but not limited to any subsequent purchaser or owner
of the Products.
Transfer or resale of a Product will automatically terminate warranty coverage with
respect to the Products.
This limited warranty dose not cover and is void with respect to the following: (i)
Products which have been improperly installed, repaired, maintained or modified
(including the antenna); (ii) Products which have been subjected to misuse
(including Products used in conjunction with hardware electrically or
mechanically incompatible or used with accessories not supplied by Sprint), abuse
accident, physical damage, abnormal operation, improper handling and storage,
neglect, exposure to fire, water or excessive moisture or dampness or extreme
changes in climate or temperature, (iii) Products operated outside published
maximum ratings; (iv) cosmetic damage; (v) Products on which warranty stickers
or Product serial numbers have been removed, altered, or rendered illegible; (vi)
customer instruction; (vii) cost of installation, removal or reinstallation; (viii) signal
reception problems (unless caused by defect in material and workmanship); (ix)
damage the result of fire, flood, acts of God or other acts which are not the fault of
Sprint and which the Product is not specified to tolerate, including damage caused
by mishandling and blown fuses; (x) consumables (such as fuses); or (xi) any
Products which have been opened, repaired, modified or altered by anyone other
than Sprint or a Sprint authorized service center.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
272
This warranty does not cover customer education, instruction, installation, set up
adjustments, or signal reception problems.
This warranty is valid only in the United States.
USE WITH ACCESSORIES NOT SUPPLIED BY SPRINT OR OTHERWISE NOT
EXPRESSLY AUTHORIZED BY SPRINT MAY BE DANGEROUS.
SPRINT SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS LIABILITY, AND SHALL HAVE NO
OBLIGATION TO PROVIDE TO BUYER ANY OTHER REMEDY, FOR ANY AND ALL
DIRECT, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, GENERAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF PROFITS, LOST SALES,
LOSS OF USE OF THE PRODUCT, OR ANTICIPATED PROFITS ARISING OUT OF
USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE ANY PRODUCT (FOR EXAMPLE, WASTED AIRTIME
CHARGES DUE TO THE MALFUNCTION OF A PRODUCT), DAMAGE DUE TO
IMPROPER OPERATION OR MAINTENANCE, INSTALLATION, CONNECTION TO
IMPROPER VOLTAGE SUPPLY. OR ATTEMPTED REPAIR OF THE PRODUCT BY
ANYONE OTHER THAN A FACILITY AUTHORIZED BY SPRINT. THIS WARRANTY
DOES NOT COVER PRODUCTS SOLD AS IS OR WITH ALL FAULTS, OR
CONSUMABLES, (SUCH AS FUSES). THIS WARRANTY DOES NOT APPLY WHEN
THE MALFUNCTION RESULTS FROM USE OF THE PRODUCT IN CONJUNCTION
WITH ACCESSORIES, PRODUCTS OR ANCILLARY OR PERIPHERAL EQUIPMENT
NOT SUPPLIED BY OR EXPRESSLY AUTHORIZED FOR USE BY SPRINT, AND
WHERE IT IS DETERMINED BY SPRINT THAT THERE IS NO FAULT WITH THE
PRODUCT ITSELF.
REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT, AS PROVIDED UNDER THE WARRANTY, IS YOUR
SOLE AND EXCLUSIVE REMEDY FOR BREACH OF THE LIMITED WARRANTY. TO
THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW,
SPRINT MAKES NO OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
WITH RESPECT TO THE PRODUCTS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR AGAINST
INFRINGEMENT WITHIN THE TIME PERIOD SPECIFIED IN THE LIMITED
WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ON THIS PRODUCT IS LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE DURATION OF THIS
WARRANTY.
Some States do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential
damages, or allow limitations on how long an implied warranty last, so the above
limitations or exclusions may not apply to you.
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may have other rights
which vary from State to State.
For other Warranty Service Information, please call PCS CUSTOMER SOLUTIONS at
1- 888- 211- 4727.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
273
Copyright(c) 2004 ACCESS Systems America Inc. ACCESS, NetFront are registered trademarks or trademarks
owned by ACCESS Co., Ltd. in Japan and selected countries worldwide. NetFront is a registered trademark of
NetFront Communications, Inc.in the United States and is used under a license. Portions of this software are
based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.
TM
Powered by JBlend Copyright 1997-2004 Aplix Corporation. All right reserved. JBlend and all JBlend-based
trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Aplix Corporation in Japan and other countries.
Copyright © 2004 Sprint Spectrum L.P. All rights reserved. No reproduction in whole or in part without prior
written approval. Sprint, the diamond logo design, and all other Sprint marks referenced herein are trademarks
of Sprint Communications Company L.P. All other trademarks are property of their respective owners.
Section 4B: Terms & Conditions / Warranty
274
Call Waiting 183
Callback Number 62
Caller ID 183
Calling in Lock Mode 67
Chat 207
Contacts
Adding 89, 93
Dialing 29
Editing 93, 95
Erasing 92
Finding 28, 90
Options 92
Saving 27
Secret 97
Index
A
Abbreviated Dialing 30, 59
Advanced Information 111
Airplane Mode 54
Alarm Clock 111
Alert Notification 42
Answering Calls 21
Any Key Answer 58
Area Name 48
Auto Answer 56
B
Background 51
Backlight Time Length 45
Battery
Capacity 16
Charging 17
Disposal 231
Installing 16
Removing 16
Standby Time 16
Talk Time 16
Current Time Setting 62
D
Dialing
Abbreviated 30, 59
Contacts 29
Numbers With Pauses 28
Options 20
PCS Services 98
Speed Dialing 30, 94, 148
Voice-Activated Dialing 124
Display Settings
Area Name 48
Background 51
Backlight Time Length 45
Display Screen 46
Font Size 52
Greeting 44
Incoming Calls 47
My Buddy 51
Screen Saver 50
Standby Mode 49
Downloading
Accessing Menus 208
Data Size 122
Erasing 70, 122
Icon Indication 121
Sorting 121
C
Calculator 112
Call Alarm
Adding 104
Alerts 105
Editing 106
Erasing 103, 109
Menu 105
Viewing 106
Call Forwarding 185
Call Guard 77
Call History
Erasing 87
Making a Call 85
Options 85
Prepending 87
Saving 86
Viewing 84
Viewing Memory 122
Index
275
E
L
Email 204
Language 63
Limit Use 68
Location Settings 53
Lock Code 67
Emergency Calling 25
End-of-Call Options 27
Event
Adding 101
Alerts 102
Erasing 103, 109
Menu 103
Viewing 103, 106
Locking Phone 66
Locking Picture 67
Locking through SMS 71
M
Making Calls 18
Making Ready Link Call 136, 137,
138
Menu Diagram 80
Message Notification 61
Messaging
Displaying 194
Folder
Creating 200
F
FCC Notice 232
Features 14
Font Size 52, 199
G
Games
Downloading 210
Playing 211
Greeting 44
Drafts 196
Editing 201
Erasing 201, 202
Outbox 197
Font Size 199
Moving a Message 201
Options 197
Picture Mail 194
Prepending 199
Sending 195, 196, 197
Storage 194
Mini Flashlight 63
Missed Call Notification 25, 138
Muting 24
My Buddy 51
My Shortcut 56
H
Hard Pause 28
Headset Mode 60
Help 6
I
Icon Indication 121, 161
In-Call Options 26
Input Mode
Alphabet Mode 33
Numbers 34
Preset Suffixes 34
Smileys 34
Symbols 34
T9 Text Mode 32
Instant Messaging 206
N
Net Guard 190
Index
276
O
Customer Solutions 3, 5, 6, 65,
71, 97, 273
Directory Assistance 7
Operator Services 7
PCS Vision
Online Picture Mail
Auto Delete 160
Managing 170
Options 172
Chat 207
Sending 171
Downloading 208
Email 204
Uploading 171
Open/Close Flip Option 57
Enabling and Disabling 72
FAQs 222
Games 210
Launching 189
Ringers 212
Screen Savers 214
Web 216
PCS Voice Command 223
Phone Number
Dialing with Pauses 28
Displaying 18
Finding 28
Saving 27
PictureMail Password 154
Pictures
Auto Delete 160
Flash 156
Multiple Shots 157
Options 155
Self-timer 156
Sending 162, 164
Settings 159
Shutter Sound 159
Status Area 160
Storing 165
Taking 153
Zoom 158
P
Passcode 71
PCS Business Connection 221
PCS Ready Link
Adding 143, 144
Alert 134, 150
Contacts List 135
Copying 141
Default View 151
Editing 145
Erasing 147
Finding 142
Making Calls
by Entering Number 138
Contact 136
Group 137
Options 140
Preparing 134
Ready Link Guard 149
Receiving 139
Redialing 140
Restarting 149
Ringer Types 150
Saving 142
Setting 133
Speakerphone 151
Speed Dialing 148
Updating 148
Power-off Tone 40
Premium Services Content 208
Prepend Dialing 87, 199
Preset Messages 61
Preset Suffixes 34
PCS Services
Call Forwarding 185
Call Waiting 183
Caller ID 183
Index
277
Q
Secret Mode 97
Security Menu
Quiet Ringer 22
Accessing 65
R
Changing the Lock Code 67
Locking Phone 66
Unlocking Phone 66
Shortcut 56
Side Key Guard 58
Silence All 43
Sleep Mode 60
Sound Settings
Silence All 43
Start-up/Power-off Tone 40
Volume Settings 24, 41
Speakerphone 23
Special Number 69
Speed Dialing 30, 94, 148
Standby Time 16
Start-up Tone 40
Symbols 34
Resetting
Phone 70
Picture Account 70
Through SMS 71
Ringer
Assigning 213
Downloading 212
Purchasing 213
Tone Length 40
Types 36
Volume 24, 41
Roaming
Analog Networks 75
Digital Networks 74
Setting 76
S
Safety Guideline 226
Scheduler
Calendar 100
Call Alarm 104
Erasing 108, 109
Event 101
T
T9 Text Input 32
Talk Time 16
Three-Way Call 184
To Do Items
Adding 107, 108
Deleting 108, 109
Editing 107
Memory 109
Setting Holidays 100
Setting the Time/Date 100
To Do 107
Screen Call
Activating 129
Erasing 131
Recording 130, 131
Reviewing 131
Selecting Announcement 130
Screen Savers
Assigning 215
Downloading 214
Purchasing 215
Viewing 107
Tone Length 40
TTY 55
Turning On and Off 15
2-Second Pause 28
U
Unlocking Phone 66
Unmute 24
Updates 203
User Address 110
User Name 187
Index
278
V
Version 110
Voice Command
Creating Address Book 224
Getting Started 224
Making a Call 225
Voice Dial
Erasing 125
Programming 124
Reviewing 125
Using 124
Voice Memo
Erasing 128
Options 127
Recording 126
Voice Prompt 40
Voicemail
Button Guide 178
Clearing Message Icon 181
Menu Key 182
Message Alerts 177
Notification 176
Options 179
Retrieving 177
Setting Up 176
Volume Settings
During a Conversation 24
Muting 24
Ringer 24, 41
W
Warranty 272
Web
Launching 189
Navigating 191
Net Guard 190
User Name 187
World Clock 49, 112
Index
279
|